11ee93e2b62a8e99216a2dce2a14f3e412ac2772
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
160 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
491 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
492 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
493 @end itemize
494
495 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
496 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
497 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
498 @itemize @bullet
499 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
500 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
501 @end itemize
502
503 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
504 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
505 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
506 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
507
508 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
509 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
510 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
511
512 @section USB Other
513 @itemize @bullet
514 @item @b{USBprog}
515 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
516
517 @item @b{USB - Presto}
518 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
519
520 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
522
523 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
524 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
525
526 @item @b{Buspirate}
527 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
528
529 @item @b{opendous}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
531
532 @item @b{estick}
533 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
534
535 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
536 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
537
538 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
539 @* The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
540 LaunchPad evaluation boards.
541 @* Link: @url{http://processors.wiki.ti.com/index.php/XDS110}
542 @* Link: @url{http://processors.wiki.ti.com/index.php/XDS_Emulation_Software_Package#XDS110_Support_Utilities}
543 @end itemize
544
545 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
546
547 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
548 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
549 these on the market.
550
551 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
552 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
553 of USB-based ones.
554
555 @itemize @bullet
556
557 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
558 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
559
560 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
561 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
562 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
563
564 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
565 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
566
567 @item @b{Wiggler2}
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
569
570 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
571 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
572
573 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
574 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
575
576 @item @b{arm-jtag}
577 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
578
579 @item @b{chameleon}
580 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
581
582 @item @b{Triton}
583 @* Unknown.
584
585 @item @b{Lattice}
586 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
587 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
588
589 @item @b{flashlink}
590 @* From STMicroelectronics;
591 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
592
593 @end itemize
594
595 @section Other...
596 @itemize @bullet
597
598 @item @b{ep93xx}
599 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
600
601 @item @b{at91rm9200}
602 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
603
604 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
605 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
606
607 @item @b{imx_gpio}
608 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
609
610 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
611 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
612 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
613
614 @end itemize
615
616 @node About Jim-Tcl
617 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
618 @cindex Jim-Tcl
619 @cindex tcl
620
621 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
622 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
623 command interpreter.
624
625 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
626 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
627 much of anything about Tcl.
628 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
629
630 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
631 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
632 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
633 OpenOCD mailing list.
634
635 @itemize @bullet
636 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
637 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
638 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
639 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
640 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
641 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
642
643 @item @b{Missing Features}
644 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
645 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
646 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
647 enabled in OpenOCD.
648
649 @item @b{Scripts}
650 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
651 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
652 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
653
654 @item @b{Commands}
655 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
656 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
657 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
658 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
659
660 @item @b{Historical Note}
661 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
662 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
663 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
664 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
665
666 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
667 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
668 @end itemize
669
670 @node Running
671 @chapter Running
672 @cindex command line options
673 @cindex logfile
674 @cindex directory search
675
676 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
677 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
678 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
679 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
680 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
681 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
682 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
683
684 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
685 tell it how each debug session should work.
686 The @option{--help} option shows:
687 @verbatim
688 bash$ openocd --help
689
690 --help | -h display this help
691 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
692 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
693 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
694 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
695 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
696 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
697 --command | -c run <command>
698 @end verbatim
699
700 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
701 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
702 To specify one or more different
703 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
704
705 @example
706 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
707 @end example
708
709 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
710 @enumerate
711 @item the current directory,
712 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
713 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
714 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
715 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
716 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
717 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
718 @end enumerate
719 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
720
721 @quotation Note
722 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
723 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
724 @end quotation
725
726 @section Simple setup, no customization
727
728 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
729 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
730 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
731 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
732 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
733
734 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
735 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
736 the server with some variation of one of the following:
737
738 @example
739 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
740 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
741 @end example
742
743 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
744 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
745 If all goes well you'll see output something like
746
747 @example
748 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
749 For bug reports, read
750 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
751 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
752 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
753 @end example
754
755 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
756 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
757 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
758
759 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
760
761 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
762 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
763 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
764 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
765 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
766 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
767 ensure that this always succeeds.
768 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
769 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
770 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
771 and then shut down without acting as a server.
772
773 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
774 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
775 those channels.
776
777 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
778 the @option{-d} option.
779
780 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
781 @option{-c} command line switch.
782
783 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
784 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
785 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
786 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
787 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
788 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
789 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
790
791 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
792 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
793
794 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
795 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
796 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
797 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
798
799 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
800 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
801
802 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
803 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
804 and start the OpenOCD server.
805 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
806 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
807 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
808 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
809
810 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
811
812 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
813 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
814 and a USB cable on the other.
815 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
816 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
817
818 @enumerate
819 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
820 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
821 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
822 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
823 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
824 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
825 debugging host.
826
827 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
828 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
829 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
830 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
831 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
832
833 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
834 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
835 with 1.2 Volt boards.
836
837 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
838 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
839 ways to connect the cable.
840 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
841 Be sure it's firmly connected.
842
843 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
844 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
845 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
846 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
847 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
848 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
849 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
850 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
851
852 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
853 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
854 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
855 but are tedious to set up.
856 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
857 adapter signals to the right board pins.
858
859 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
860 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
861 you are using to run OpenOCD.
862 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
863
864 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
865 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
866 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
867 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
868
869 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
870 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
871 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
872
873 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
874 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
875 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
876 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
877
878 @end enumerate
879
880 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
881 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
882 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
883
884 @section Project Directory
885
886 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
887
888 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
889 single directory for your work with a given board.
890 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
891 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
892 files accessed through semihosting,
893 and for code you upload to the target board.
894 It is also the natural place to write files,
895 such as log files and data you download from the board.
896
897 @section Configuration Basics
898
899 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
900 a variety of ways you can mix them.
901 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
902
903 @itemize
904 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
905 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
906 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
907 @end itemize
908
909 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
910 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
911 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
912
913 @example
914 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
915
916 # GDB can also flash my flash!
917 gdb_memory_map enable
918 gdb_flash_program enable
919
920 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
921 @end example
922
923 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
924
925 @example
926 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
927 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
928 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
929 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
930 @end example
931
932 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
933 each supporting a different development task.
934 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
935 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
936
937 @quotation Important
938 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
939 problems with how it treats variables.
940 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
941 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
942 that can be tested in a later script.
943 @end quotation
944
945 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
946 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
947 to simplify your work.
948
949 @section User Config Files
950 @cindex config file, user
951 @cindex user config file
952 @cindex config file, overview
953
954 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
955 in one place.
956 One of the following will match your situation best:
957
958 @itemize
959 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
960 provided by someone else.
961 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
962 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
963 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
964 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
965 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
966 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
967
968 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
969 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
970
971 @enumerate
972 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
973 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
974 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
975 @end enumerate
976
977 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
978 The first is an interface config file.
979 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
980 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
981 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
982 meet your deadline:
983
984 @example
985 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
986 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
987 @end example
988
989 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
990 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
991 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
992 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
993
994 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
995 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
996 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
997 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
998 target and board
999 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1000 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1001
1002 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1003 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1004 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1005 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1006
1007 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1008 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1009 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1010 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1011 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1012
1013 @quotation Note
1014 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1015 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1016 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1017 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1018 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1019 @end quotation
1020
1021 @item
1022 You may may need to write some C code.
1023 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1024 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1025 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1026 a new chip architecture.
1027 @end itemize
1028
1029 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1030 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1031 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1032
1033 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1034 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1035 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1036 @itemize
1037
1038 @item
1039 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1040 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1041 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1042 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1043
1044 @item
1045 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1046 @cindex vector_catch
1047 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1048 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1049 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1050 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1051 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1052 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1053
1054 @item
1055 You might need to override some defaults.
1056 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1057 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1058
1059 @item
1060 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1061 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1062 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1063 @end itemize
1064
1065 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1066
1067 A few project-specific utility
1068 routines may well speed up your work.
1069 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1070
1071 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1072 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1073 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1074 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1075 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1076 may help:
1077
1078 @example
1079 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1080 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1081 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1082 # Leave the CPU halted.
1083 reset init
1084
1085 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1086 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1087
1088 # Start running.
1089 resume 0x20000000
1090 @}
1091 @end example
1092
1093 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1094 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1095 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1096 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1097 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1098
1099 @example
1100 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1101 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1102 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1103 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1104 reset init
1105
1106 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1107 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1108 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1109 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1110 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1111 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1112 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1113
1114 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1115 reset run
1116 @}
1117 @end example
1118
1119 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1120 from NAND.
1121 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1122 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1123 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1124
1125 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1126 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1127
1128 @section Target Software Changes
1129
1130 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1131 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1132 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1133 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1134 handling issues like:
1135
1136 @itemize @bullet
1137
1138 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1139 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1140 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1141 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1142 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1143 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1144 your debug sessions.
1145
1146 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1147 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1148 That might however be your only option.
1149
1150 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1151 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1152 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1153 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1154 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1155 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1156 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1157 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1158 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1159 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1160 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1161 instead of the whole thing.
1162 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1163 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1164
1165 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1166 @cindex ARM semihosting
1167 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1168 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1169 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1170 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1171 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1172 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1173 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1174 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1175 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1176 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1177 NAND or SPI flash.
1178
1179 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1180 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1181 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1182 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1183 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1184
1185 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1186 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1187 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1188 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1189 registers which can be used to change various features including
1190 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1191 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1192 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1193 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1194 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1195
1196 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1197 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1198 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1199 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1200 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1201
1202 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1203 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1204 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1205 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1206 early code execution can be debugged
1207 or firmware can be replaced.
1208
1209 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1210 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1211 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1212 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1213 operations like writing to memory.)
1214
1215 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1216 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1217 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1218 various kinds of message.
1219 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1220
1221 @end itemize
1222
1223 @section Target Hardware Setup
1224
1225 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1226 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1227 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1228 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1229 working with.}
1230
1231 Common issues include:
1232
1233 @itemize @bullet
1234
1235 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1236 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1237 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1238 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1239 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1240 or one from a daughtercard).
1241 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1242 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1243
1244 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1245 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1246 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1247 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1248 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1249 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1250
1251 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1252 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1253 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1254 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1255 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1256
1257
1258 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1259 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1260 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1261 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1262 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1263 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1264 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1265
1266 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1267 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1268 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1269 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1270 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1271
1272 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1273 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1274 used to start booting.
1275
1276 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1277 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1278 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1279 multiple audio codec chips).
1280 This interacts with software
1281 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1282 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1283 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1284 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1285 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1286 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1287 audio or video codecs are used.
1288
1289 @end itemize
1290
1291 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1292 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1293 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1294 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1295 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1296 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1297 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1298 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1299 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1300 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1301
1302
1303 @node Config File Guidelines
1304 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1305
1306 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1307 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1308 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1309 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1310
1311 You should find the following directories under
1312 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1313 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1314 @itemize @bullet
1315 @item @file{interface} ...
1316 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1317 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1318 @item @file{board} ...
1319 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1320 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1321
1322 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1323 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1324 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1325 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1326 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1327 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1328 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1329 a CPU and an FPGA.
1330 @item @file{target} ...
1331 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1332 on a chip
1333 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1334 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1335 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1336 the target config file defines all of them.
1337 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1338 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1339 @end itemize
1340
1341 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1342 file may override features in any of the above files by
1343 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1344 commands specific to their situation.
1345
1346 @section Interface Config Files
1347
1348 The user config file
1349 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1350
1351 @example
1352 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1353 @end example
1354
1355 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1356 in use today with OpenOCD.
1357 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1358 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1359
1360 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1361 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1362 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1363 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1364 and need to provide a driver for it.
1365
1366 @section Board Config Files
1367 @cindex config file, board
1368 @cindex board config file
1369
1370 The user config file
1371 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1372
1373 @example
1374 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1375 @end example
1376
1377 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1378 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1379 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1380
1381 @enumerate
1382 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1383 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1384 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1385 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1386 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1387 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1388 @end enumerate
1389
1390 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1391 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1392 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1393 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1394
1395 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1396 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1397 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1398 configuration works.
1399
1400 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1401
1402 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1403 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1404 convention on how to use certain variables.
1405
1406 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1407 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1408 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1409 used at will within a target configuration file.
1410
1411 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1412 for a board with three chips:
1413
1414 @example
1415 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1416 set CHIPNAME network
1417 set ENDIAN big
1418 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1419 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1420 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1421 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1422
1423 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1424 set CHIPNAME video
1425 set ENDIAN little
1426 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1427 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1428 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1429 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1430
1431 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1432 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1433 unset ENDIAN
1434 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1435 @end example
1436
1437 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1438 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1439 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1440 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1441 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1442 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1443 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1444 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1445
1446 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1447 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1448 naming collisions.
1449
1450 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1451 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1452 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1453 up other clocks and peripherals.
1454
1455 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1456 @cindex variable names
1457
1458 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1459 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1460 one such chip (as shown above).
1461 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1462 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1463 to promote consistency and
1464 so that board files can override target defaults.
1465
1466 Inputs to target config files include:
1467
1468 @itemize @bullet
1469 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1470 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1471 tap identifier dotted names.
1472 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1473 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1474 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1475 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1476 Chips that can't change endianess don't need to use this variable.
1477 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1478 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1479 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1480 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1481 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1482 @end itemize
1483
1484 Outputs from target config files include:
1485
1486 @itemize @bullet
1487 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1488 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1489 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1490 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1491 specific to that board and that target.
1492 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1493 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1494 @end itemize
1495
1496 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1497 @cindex event, reset-init
1498 @cindex reset-init handler
1499
1500 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1501 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1502 fully set up yet.
1503 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1504 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1505 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1506 handler is one of the most important.
1507
1508 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1509 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1510 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1511 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1512 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1513
1514 @quotation Note
1515 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1516 are included here.
1517 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1518 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1519 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1520 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1521 @end quotation
1522
1523 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1524 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1525 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1526 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1527 those as parameters.
1528 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1529 and disabling the watchdog.
1530 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1531 the next developer doing such work.
1532 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1533
1534 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1535 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1536 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1537 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1538
1539 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1540
1541 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1542 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1543 a low JTAG clock rate.
1544 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1545 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1546 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1547 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1548 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1549 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1550 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1551
1552 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1553 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1554 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1555 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1556 which might be less than that.
1557
1558 @quotation Warning
1559 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1560 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1561 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1562 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1563 @end quotation
1564
1565 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1566 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1567 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1568 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1569 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1570 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1571
1572 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1573 @subsection The init_board procedure
1574 @cindex init_board procedure
1575
1576 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1577 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1578 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1579 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1580 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1581 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1582 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1583 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1584 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1585 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1586 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1587 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1588
1589 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1590 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1591
1592 @example
1593 ### board_file.cfg ###
1594
1595 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1596 source [find target/target.cfg]
1597
1598 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1599 # enables fast on-board clock source
1600 # configures the chip to use it
1601 @}
1602
1603 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1604 proc init_board @{@} @{
1605 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1606
1607 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1608 adapter_khz 100
1609 @}
1610
1611 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1612 enable_fast_clock
1613 adapter_khz 10000
1614 @}
1615 @}
1616 @end example
1617
1618 @section Target Config Files
1619 @cindex config file, target
1620 @cindex target config file
1621
1622 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1623 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1624 more target config files like this:
1625
1626 @example
1627 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1628 @end example
1629
1630 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1631 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1632 In summary the target files should contain
1633
1634 @enumerate
1635 @item Set defaults
1636 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1637 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1638 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1639 @item On-Chip flash
1640 @end enumerate
1641
1642 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1643 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1644 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1645
1646 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1647 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1648 can talk to the chip.
1649 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1650 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1651 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1652 and other processing engines.
1653
1654 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1655
1656 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1657 letting board config files express environment-specific
1658 differences in how things should be set up.
1659
1660 @example
1661 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1662 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1663 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1664 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1665 @} else @{
1666 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1667 @}
1668
1669 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1670 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1671 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1672 @} else @{
1673 set _ENDIAN little
1674 @}
1675
1676 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1677 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1678 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1679 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1680 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1681 @} else @{
1682 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1683 @}
1684 @end example
1685 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1686
1687 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1688 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1689 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1690
1691 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1692 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1693 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1694
1695 @example
1696 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1697 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1698 @end example
1699
1700 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1701 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1702 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1703 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1704 for taps.
1705
1706 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1707 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1708 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1709 looks (in part) like this:
1710
1711 @example
1712 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1713 @end example
1714
1715 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1716 to source such a config file twice, with different
1717 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1718 it adds a different TAP each time.
1719
1720 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1721 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1722 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1723 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1724
1725 @example
1726 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1727 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1728 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1729 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1730 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1731 @end example
1732
1733 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1734 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1735
1736 @itemize
1737 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1738 plus a JRC to enable them
1739 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1740 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1741 is not currently used)
1742 @end itemize
1743
1744 @subsection Add CPU targets
1745
1746 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1747 GDB and other commands can use it.
1748 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1749 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1750 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1751 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1752
1753 @example
1754 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1755 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1756 @end example
1757
1758 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1759 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1760 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1761 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1762 a work area if you can.
1763 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1764
1765 @example
1766 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1767 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1768 @end example
1769
1770 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1771 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1772 @cindex SMP
1773 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1774
1775 @example
1776 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1777 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1778 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1779 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1780 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1781 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1782 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1783 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1784 @end example
1785 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1786 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1787 @itemize @bullet
1788 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1789 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1790 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1791 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1792 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1793 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1794 @end itemize
1795
1796 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1797 command have been implemented.
1798 @itemize @bullet
1799 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1800 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1801 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1802 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1803 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1804 following example.
1805 @end itemize
1806
1807 @example
1808 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1809 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1810 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1811 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1812 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1813 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1814 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1815 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1816 > resume
1817 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1818 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1819 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1820 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1821 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1822 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1823 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1824 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1825 @end example
1826
1827
1828 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1829
1830 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1831 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1832 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1833
1834 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1835 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1836 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1837 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1838 both signals.
1839
1840 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1841 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1842 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1843 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1844 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1845 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1846 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1847 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1848 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1849 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1850 not available.)
1851
1852 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1853 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1854 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1855 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1856 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1857 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1858 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1859 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1860
1861 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1862 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1863 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1864 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1865 slower clock than they will use later.
1866 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1867 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1868 than they will use later.
1869 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1870
1871 @quotation Important
1872 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1873 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1874 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1875 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1876 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1877 @end quotation
1878
1879 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1880 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1881 @cindex init_targets procedure
1882
1883 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1884 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1885 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1886 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1887 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1888 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1889 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1890 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1891 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1892
1893 @example
1894 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1895
1896 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1897 # basic initialization procedure ...
1898 @}
1899
1900 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1901 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1902 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1903 @}
1904
1905 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1906
1907 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1908
1909 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1910 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1911 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1912 @}
1913 @end example
1914
1915 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1916 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1917
1918 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1919
1920 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1921 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1922
1923 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1924 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1925 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1926
1927 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1928 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1929 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1930 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1931 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1932 events already assigned.
1933
1934 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1935
1936 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1937 special high speed download features - enable it.
1938
1939 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1940
1941 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1942 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1943 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1944 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1945 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1946 If you are using an external trace port,
1947 configure it in your board config file.
1948 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1949 configure it in your target config file.
1950
1951 @example
1952 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1953 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1954 @end example
1955
1956 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1957
1958 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1959
1960 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1961 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1962 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1963 the TARGET (chip) file.
1964
1965 Examples:
1966 @itemize @bullet
1967 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1968 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1969 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1970 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1971 @end itemize
1972
1973 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1974 @section Translating Configuration Files
1975 @cindex translation
1976 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1977 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1978 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1979 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1980 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1981 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1982
1983 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1984 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1985 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1986 convert other scripts later on.
1987
1988 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1989 replace job:
1990
1991 @example
1992 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1993 #
1994 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1995 #
1996 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1997 #
1998 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1999
2000 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2001 global TARGETNAME
2002
2003 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2004
2005 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2006 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2007 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2008 @}
2009 @end example
2010
2011
2012
2013 @node Server Configuration
2014 @chapter Server Configuration
2015 @cindex initialization
2016 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2017 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2018 supported.
2019
2020 @anchor{configurationstage}
2021 @section Configuration Stage
2022 @cindex configuration stage
2023 @cindex config command
2024
2025 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2026 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2027 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2028 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2029 inside startup scripts.
2030
2031 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2032 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2033 which may be issued interactively.
2034 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2035 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2036
2037 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2038 flash banks,
2039 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2040 and other basic setup.
2041 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2042 may access or activate TAPs.
2043 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2044 longer be issued.
2045
2046 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2047 @section Entering the Run Stage
2048
2049 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2050 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2051 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2052 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2053 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2054 You should see no errors at this point.
2055 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2056 commands you used to configure the server.
2057 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2058 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2059 on the scan chain.
2060
2061 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2062 become available.
2063 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2064 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2065 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2066 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2067 entry to the run stage.
2068
2069 @deffn {Config Command} init
2070 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2071 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2072 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2073 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2074 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2075 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2076
2077 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2078 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2079 configuration files and/or command line options.
2080
2081 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2082 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2083 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2084 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2085 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2086 @end deffn
2087
2088 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2089 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2090 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2091
2092 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2093 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2094 scan chain.
2095 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2096 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2097
2098 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2099 they return.
2100 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2101 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2102 @end deffn
2103
2104 @anchor{tcpipports}
2105 @section TCP/IP Ports
2106 @cindex TCP port
2107 @cindex server
2108 @cindex port
2109 @cindex security
2110 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2111 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2112 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2113
2114 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2115 access using one or more of these ports.
2116 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2117 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2118 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2119
2120 @anchor{gdb_port}
2121 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2122 @cindex GDB server
2123 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2124 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2125 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2126 the normal use cases.
2127
2128 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2129 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2130 disables the gdb server.
2131
2132 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2133 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2134
2135 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2136 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2137
2138 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2139 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2140 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2141
2142 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2143 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2144 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2145 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2146 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2147 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2148 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2149 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2150 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2151
2152 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2153 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2154 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2155 @end deffn
2156
2157 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2158 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2159 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2160 output from the Tcl engine.
2161 Intended as a machine interface.
2162 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2163 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2164 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2165 @end deffn
2166
2167 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2168 Specify or query the
2169 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2170 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2171 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2172 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2173 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2174 @end deffn
2175
2176 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2177 @section GDB Configuration
2178 @cindex GDB
2179 @cindex GDB configuration
2180 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2181 The ones listed here are static and global.
2182 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2183 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2184
2185 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2186 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2187 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2188 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2189 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2190 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2191 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2192 @end deffn
2193
2194 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2195 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2196 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2197 vFlash packet is received.
2198 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2199 @end deffn
2200
2201 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2202 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2203 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2204 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2205 for flash programming to work.
2206 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2207 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2208 @end deffn
2209
2210 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2211 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2212 by GDB memory read packets.
2213 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2214 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2215 @end deffn
2216
2217 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_register_access_error (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2218 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2219 packets report errors or not.
2220 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2221 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2222 @end deffn
2223
2224 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2225 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2226 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2227 @end deffn
2228
2229 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2230 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2231
2232 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2233 @end deffn
2234
2235 @anchor{eventpolling}
2236 @section Event Polling
2237
2238 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2239 where significant events can happen at any time.
2240 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2241 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2242 or to GDB.
2243
2244 Examples of such events include:
2245
2246 @itemize
2247 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2248 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2249 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2250 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2251 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2252 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2253 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2254 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2255 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2256 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2257 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2258 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2259 @end itemize
2260
2261 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2262 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2263 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2264 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2265 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2266
2267 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2268 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2269 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2270 to the various active targets.
2271 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2272 which is normally done in the background.
2273
2274 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2275 Poll the current target for its current state.
2276 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2277 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2278 specific information about the current state is printed.
2279 An optional parameter
2280 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2281
2282 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2283 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2284 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2285 @example
2286 > poll
2287 background polling: on
2288 target state: halted
2289 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2290 current mode: Supervisor
2291 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2292 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2293 >
2294 @end example
2295 @end deffn
2296
2297 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2298 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2299 @cindex config file, interface
2300 @cindex interface config file
2301
2302 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2303 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2304 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2305
2306 @quotation Note
2307 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2308 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2309 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2310 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2311 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2312 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2313 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2314 @end quotation
2315
2316 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2317 through commands in an interface configuration
2318 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2319 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2320
2321 @example
2322 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2323 @end example
2324
2325 These commands tell
2326 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2327 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2328
2329 @example
2330 # jlink interface
2331 interface jlink
2332 @end example
2333
2334 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2335
2336
2337 @section Interface Configuration
2338
2339 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2340 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2341 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2342
2343 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2344 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2345 target.
2346 @end deffn
2347
2348 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2349 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2350 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2351 @end deffn
2352 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2353 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2354 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2355 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2356 the hardware can support.
2357 @end deffn
2358
2359
2360
2361 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2362 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2363 @end deffn
2364
2365 @section Interface Drivers
2366
2367 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2368 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2369 available at run time.
2370
2371 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2372 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2373 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2374 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2375
2376 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2377 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2378 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2379 @end deffn
2380
2381 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2382 Displays status of RTCK option.
2383 Optionally sets that option first.
2384 @end deffn
2385 @end deffn
2386
2387 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2388 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2389 This has one driver-specific command:
2390
2391 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2392 Logs some status
2393 @end deffn
2394 @end deffn
2395
2396 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2397 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2398 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2399 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2400 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2401 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2402 @end deffn
2403
2404 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2405 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2406
2407 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2408 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2409 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2410 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2411 @example
2412 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2413 @end example
2414 @end deffn
2415
2416 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2417 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2418 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2419 @end deffn
2420
2421 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2422 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2423 @end deffn
2424 @end deffn
2425
2426 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2427 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2428 @end deffn
2429
2430 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2431 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2432 @end deffn
2433
2434 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2435 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2436 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2437
2438 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2439 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2440
2441 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2442 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2443
2444 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2445 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2446 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2447 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2448 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2449 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2450
2451 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2452 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2453 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2454 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2455 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2456
2457 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2458 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2459 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2460 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2461
2462 @itemize @minus
2463 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2464 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2465 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2466 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2467 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2468 switching data and direction as necessary
2469 @end itemize
2470
2471 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2472 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2473
2474 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2475 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2476 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2477 @example
2478 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2479 @end example
2480 @end deffn
2481
2482 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2483 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2484 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2485 during device selection.
2486 @end deffn
2487
2488 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2489 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2490 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2491 is connected to the host.
2492 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2493 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2494 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2495 @end deffn
2496
2497 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>:<port>[,<port>]...
2498 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2499 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2500 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2501 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2502 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2503
2504 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2505 @end deffn
2506
2507 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2508 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2509 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2510 @end deffn
2511
2512 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2513 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2514 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2515 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2516 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2517 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2518 and initially asserted reset signals.
2519 @end deffn
2520
2521 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2522 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2523 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2524 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2525 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2526 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2527 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2528 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2529 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2530 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2531 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2532
2533 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2534 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2535 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2536 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2537 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2538 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2539
2540 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2541 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2542 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2543 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2544 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2545 are always driven by the FTDI.
2546
2547 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2548 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2549 @var{name}.
2550 @end deffn
2551
2552 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2553 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2554 @itemize @minus
2555 @item @option{0}, drive low
2556 @item @option{1}, drive high
2557 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2558 @end itemize
2559 @end deffn
2560
2561 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2562 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2563 @end deffn
2564
2565 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2566 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2567
2568 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2569 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2570 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2571 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2572 @itemize @minus
2573 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2574 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2575 @end itemize
2576 @end deffn
2577
2578 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2579 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2580
2581 @end deffn
2582
2583 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2584 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2585 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2586 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2587
2588 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2589 @itemize @minus
2590 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2591 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2592 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2593 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2594 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2595 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2596 @end itemize
2597
2598 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2599 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2600 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2601 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2602 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2603 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2604 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2605 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2606
2607 FT232R
2608 @itemize @minus
2609 @item bit 7 - RI
2610 @item bit 6 - DCD
2611 @item bit 5 - DSR
2612 @item bit 4 - DTR
2613 @item bit 3 - CTS
2614 @item bit 2 - RTS
2615 @item bit 1 - RXD
2616 @item bit 0 - TXD
2617 @end itemize
2618
2619 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2620 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2621
2622 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2623 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2624 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2625 @end deffn
2626
2627 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2628 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2629 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2630 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2631 @end deffn
2632
2633 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2634 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2635 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2636 @end deffn
2637
2638 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2639 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2640 @end deffn
2641
2642 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2643 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2644 @end deffn
2645
2646 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2647 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2648 @end deffn
2649
2650 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2651 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2652 @end deffn
2653
2654 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2655 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2656 @end deffn
2657
2658 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2659 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2660 @end deffn
2661
2662 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2663 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2664 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2665 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2666 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2667 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2668 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2669 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2670 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2671 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2672 @end deffn
2673
2674 @end deffn
2675
2676 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2677 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2678 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2679 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2680
2681 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2682 processors which are being simulated.
2683
2684 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2685 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2686 sockets instead of TCP.
2687 @end deffn
2688
2689 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2690 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2691 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2692 @end deffn
2693
2694 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2695 something like:
2696
2697 @example
2698 interface remote_bitbang
2699 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2700 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2701 @end example
2702
2703 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2704 named mysocket:
2705
2706 @example
2707 interface remote_bitbang
2708 remote_bitbang_port 0
2709 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2710 @end example
2711 @end deffn
2712
2713 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2714 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2715 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2716 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2717
2718 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2719 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2720 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2721 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2722 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2723 @end deffn
2724
2725 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2726 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2727 default values are used.
2728 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2729 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2730 @example
2731 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2732 @end example
2733 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2734 @example
2735 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2736 @end example
2737 @end deffn
2738
2739 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2740 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2741 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2742 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2743 target board.
2744
2745 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2746 @example
2747 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2748 reset_config srst_only
2749 @end example
2750 @end deffn
2751
2752 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2753 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2754 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2755 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2756 @end deffn
2757
2758 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2759 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2760 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2761 @end deffn
2762
2763 @end deffn
2764
2765 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2766 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2767 This has one driver-specific command:
2768
2769 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2770 Display either the address of the I/O port
2771 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2772 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2773 This is a write-once setting.
2774 @end deffn
2775 @end deffn
2776
2777 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2778 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2779 transports.
2780
2781 @quotation Compatibility Note
2782 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2783 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2784 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2785 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2786 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2787 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2788 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2789 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2790 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2791 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2792 @end quotation
2793
2794 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2795 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2796 states.
2797 @end deffn
2798 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2799 Display free device internal memory.
2800 @end deffn
2801 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2802 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2803 command version.
2804 @end deffn
2805 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2806 Display the device configuration.
2807 @end deffn
2808 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2809 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2810 power state.
2811 @end deffn
2812 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2813 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2814 @end deffn
2815 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2816 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2817 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2818 IP configuration.
2819 @end deffn
2820 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2821 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2822 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2823 @end deffn
2824 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2825 Reset the current configuration.
2826 @end deffn
2827 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2828 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2829 @end deffn
2830 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2831 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2832 pairs.
2833
2834 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2835 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2836 @example
2837 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2838 @end example
2839 @end deffn
2840 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2841 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2842 pairs.
2843
2844 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2845 @example
2846 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2847 77a90000
2848 @end example
2849 @end deffn
2850 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2851 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2852 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2853 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2854 instead.
2855
2856 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2857 @end deffn
2858 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2859 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2860 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2861
2862 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2863 @end deffn
2864 @end deffn
2865
2866 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2867 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2868 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2869 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2870 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2871 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2872 configuration script.
2873
2874 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2875 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2876 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2877 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2878 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2879
2880 Known limitations:
2881 @itemize @bullet
2882 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2883 and 2.7 MHz.
2884 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2885 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2886 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2887 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2888 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2889 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2890 communications with the target.
2891 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2892 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2893 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2894 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2895 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2896 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2897 @end itemize
2898
2899 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2900 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2901 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2902 @end deffn
2903
2904 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2905 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2906 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2907 @end deffn
2908
2909 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2910 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2911 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2912 target as a side-effect.
2913 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2914 @end deffn
2915
2916 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2917 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2918 version, and target voltage.
2919 @end deffn
2920 @end deffn
2921
2922 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2923 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2924 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2925 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2926 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2927
2928 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2929 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2930 This is a write-once setting.
2931 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2932
2933 @itemize @minus
2934 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2935 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2936 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2937 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2938 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2939 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2940 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2941 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2942 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2943 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2944 some versions of
2945 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2946 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2947 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2948 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2949 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2950 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2951 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2952 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2953 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2954 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2955 @end itemize
2956 @end deffn
2957
2958 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2959 Display either the address of the I/O port
2960 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2961 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2962 This is a write-once setting.
2963
2964 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2965 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2966 you may encounter a problem.
2967 @end deffn
2968
2969 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2970 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2971 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2972 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2973 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2974 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2975
2976 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2977 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2978 @quotation Tip
2979 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2980 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2981 @example
2982 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2983 > adapter_khz 500
2984 @end example
2985 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2986 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2987 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2988 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2989 large set of samples.
2990 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2991 @example
2992 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2993 @end example
2994 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
2995 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2996
2997 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2998 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2999 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3000 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3001 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
3002 @end quotation
3003 @end deffn
3004
3005 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3006 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3007 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3008 @end deffn
3009
3010 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3011 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3012
3013 @example
3014 interface parport
3015 parport_port 0x278
3016 parport_cable wiggler
3017 @end example
3018 @end deffn
3019
3020 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3021 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3022 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3023 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3024 @end deffn
3025 @end deffn
3026
3027 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3028 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3029 @end deffn
3030
3031 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3032 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3033 @end deffn
3034
3035 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3036 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3037
3038 @quotation Note
3039 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3040 which are not currently documented here.
3041 @end quotation
3042 @end deffn
3043
3044 @anchor{hla_interface}
3045 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3046 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3047 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3048 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3049
3050 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK and TI ICDI.
3051 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3052 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3053 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3054 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3055
3056 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3057 Currently Not Supported.
3058 @end deffn
3059
3060 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3061 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3062 @end deffn
3063
3064 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
3065 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3066 @end deffn
3067
3068 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3069 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3070 @end deffn
3071
3072 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3073 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3074 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3075 @end deffn
3076 @end deffn
3077
3078 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3079 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3080 @end deffn
3081
3082 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3083 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3084 @end deffn
3085
3086 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3087 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3088 @end deffn
3089
3090 @quotation Note
3091 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3092 which are not currently documented here.
3093 @end quotation
3094
3095 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3096 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3097 No arguments: print status.
3098 @end deffn
3099
3100 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3101 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3102 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3103
3104 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3105 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3106 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3107 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3108 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3109 configuration on exit.
3110
3111 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3112 pinout.
3113
3114 @end deffn
3115
3116 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3117 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3118 of the one which is most popular.
3119
3120 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3121
3122 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3123 pinout.
3124
3125 @end deffn
3126
3127
3128 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3129 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3130 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3131
3132 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3133 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3134 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3135
3136 @itemize @minus
3137 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3138 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3139 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3140 @end itemize
3141 @end deffn
3142
3143 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3144 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3145 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3146 @end deffn
3147 @end deffn
3148
3149 @section Transport Configuration
3150 @cindex Transport
3151 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3152 and the debug adapter you are using,
3153 several transports may be available to
3154 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3155 @deffn Command {transport list}
3156 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3157 version of OpenOCD.
3158 @end deffn
3159
3160 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3161 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3162
3163 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3164 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3165 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3166 adapter's driver).
3167
3168 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3169 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3170 supported by the debug adapter.
3171
3172 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3173 transport, if any.
3174 @end deffn
3175
3176 @subsection JTAG Transport
3177 @cindex JTAG
3178 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3179 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3180 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3181 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3182 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3183 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3184
3185 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3186 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3187 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3188 hla_jtag}.
3189
3190 @subsection SWD Transport
3191 @cindex SWD
3192 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3193 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3194 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3195 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3196 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3197 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3198 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3199
3200 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3201 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3202 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3203 hla_swd}.
3204
3205 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3206 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3207 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3208 expected to change.
3209 @end deffn
3210 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3211 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3212 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3213 No parameters: displays current settings.
3214 @end deffn
3215
3216 @subsection SPI Transport
3217 @cindex SPI
3218 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3219 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3220 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3221 solution for flash programming.
3222
3223 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3224 @section JTAG Speed
3225 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3226 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3227 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3228 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3229 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3230 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3231 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3232 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3233 power management software that may be active.
3234
3235 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3236 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3237 target event handler.
3238 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3239 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3240 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3241 sets up those clocks).
3242 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3243 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3244 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3245 in the target config file.
3246 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3247 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3248 config file instead.
3249 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3250 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3251 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3252
3253 @example
3254 jtag_rclk 3000
3255 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3256 @end example
3257
3258 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3259 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3260 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3261 may not be the fastest solution.
3262
3263 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3264 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3265 which support adaptive clocking.
3266
3267 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3268 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3269 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3270 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3271 than the speed specified.
3272
3273 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3274 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3275 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3276 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3277
3278 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3279 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3280 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3281 JTAG clocking after setup.
3282 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3283 If the interface device can not
3284 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3285 @end deffn
3286
3287 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3288 @cindex adaptive clocking
3289 @cindex RTCK
3290 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3291 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3292 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3293 @example
3294 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3295 jtag_rclk 3000
3296 @end example
3297 @end defun
3298
3299 @node Reset Configuration
3300 @chapter Reset Configuration
3301 @cindex Reset Configuration
3302
3303 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3304 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3305 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3306 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3307 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3308 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3309 Please see the various board files for examples.
3310
3311 @quotation Note
3312 To maintainers and integrators:
3313 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3314 Normally the board configuration file
3315 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3316 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3317
3318 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3319 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3320 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3321 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3322 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3323 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3324 @end quotation
3325
3326 @section Types of Reset
3327
3328 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3329 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3330 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3331
3332 @itemize @bullet
3333 @item
3334 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3335 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3336 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3337 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3338 @item
3339 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3340 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3341 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3342 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3343 @item
3344 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3345 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3346 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3347 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3348 @item
3349 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3350 several other types of reset.
3351 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3352 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3353 There may be individual module resets.
3354 @end itemize
3355
3356 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3357 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3358 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3359 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3360 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3361 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3362 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3363 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3364 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3365
3366 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3367 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3368
3369 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3370 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3371 common issues are:
3372
3373 @itemize @bullet
3374
3375 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3376 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3377 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3378 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3379 when either of those signals is not connected.
3380 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3381 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3382 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3383 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3384
3385 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3386 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3387 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3388 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3389
3390 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3391 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3392 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3393 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3394 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3395 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3396 hardware debouncing.
3397 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3398 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3399
3400 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3401 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3402 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3403 to use push/pull output drivers.
3404 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3405 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3406 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3407 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3408
3409 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3410 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3411 issues (not limited to errata).
3412 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3413 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3414 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3415 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3416 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3417 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3418 @end itemize
3419
3420 There can also be other issues.
3421 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3422 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3423 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3424 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3425 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3426 Agreement (NDA).
3427
3428 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3429 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3430 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3431
3432 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3433 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3434
3435 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3436
3437 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3438 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3439 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3440 allowing it to be deasserted.
3441 @end deffn
3442
3443 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3444 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3445 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3446 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3447 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3448 @end deffn
3449
3450 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3451 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3452 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3453 allowing it to be deasserted.
3454 @end deffn
3455
3456 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3457 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3458 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3459 @end deffn
3460
3461 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3462 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3463 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3464 configuration scripts.
3465
3466 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3467 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3468 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3469 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3470 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3471 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3472 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3473 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3474
3475 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3476 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3477 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3478 -- may be specified at a time.
3479 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3480 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3481 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3482 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3483 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3484
3485 @itemize
3486 @item
3487 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3488 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3489 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3490 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3491 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3492
3493 @quotation Tip
3494 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3495 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3496 @end quotation
3497
3498 @item
3499 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3500 signal implementations.
3501 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3502 indicating everything behaves normally.
3503 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3504 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3505 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3506 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3507 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3508 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3509 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3510
3511 @item
3512 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3513 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3514 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3515 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3516 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3517 while SRST is asserted.
3518 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3519 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3520
3521 @item
3522 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3523 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3524 is required to use this option.
3525 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3526 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3527 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3528 be asserted before any target connection.
3529 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3530 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3531 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3532 @end itemize
3533
3534 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3535 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3536 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3537 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3538 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3539
3540 @itemize
3541 @item
3542 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3543 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3544 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3545 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3546
3547 @item
3548 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3549 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3550 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3551 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3552 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3553 @end itemize
3554 @end deffn
3555
3556 @section Custom Reset Handling
3557 @cindex events
3558
3559 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3560 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3561 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3562 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3563 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3564 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3565
3566 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3567 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3568 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3569 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3570 want to reset everything at once.
3571
3572 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3573 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3574 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3575 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3576 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3577 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3578 needs special attention.
3579
3580 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3581 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3582 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3583 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3584 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3585 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3586 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3587 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3588
3589 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3590 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3591 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3592 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3593 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3594
3595 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3596 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3597 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3598 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3599 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3600 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3601 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3602 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3603 or potentially some other value.
3604
3605 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3606 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3607 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3608 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3609 (or their associated targets)
3610 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3611
3612 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3613 they return.
3614 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3615 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3616 @end deffn
3617
3618 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3619 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3620 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3621 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3622 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3623 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3624 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3625 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3626 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3627 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3628 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3629 @end deffn
3630
3631 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3632 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3633 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3634 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3635 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3636 @end deffn
3637
3638
3639 @node TAP Declaration
3640 @chapter TAP Declaration
3641 @cindex TAP declaration
3642 @cindex TAP configuration
3643
3644 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3645 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3646
3647 @itemize @bullet
3648 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3649 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3650 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3651 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3652 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3653 start running that code.
3654 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3655 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3656 and missing connections.
3657 @end itemize
3658
3659 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3660 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3661 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3662 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3663 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3664
3665 @section Scan Chains
3666 @cindex scan chain
3667
3668 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3669 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3670 They also need to be added to
3671 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3672 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3673 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3674 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3675 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3676 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3677 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3678 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3679
3680 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3681 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3682 command, presented in the next chapter.
3683 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3684 debugging targets.)
3685 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3686
3687 @verbatim
3688 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3689 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3690 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3691 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3692 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3693 @end verbatim
3694
3695 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3696 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3697 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3698 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3699 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3700 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3701 until they are told to do so.
3702
3703 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3704 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3705 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3706 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3707
3708 @example
3709 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3710 @end example
3711
3712 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3713 by a given chip.
3714 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3715 and so forth.
3716 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3717 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3718 both inside a single chip and between them.
3719 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3720
3721 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3722 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3723 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3724 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3725 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3726 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3727 includes commands something like this:
3728
3729 @example
3730 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3731 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3732 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3733 @end example
3734
3735 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3736 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3737 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3738
3739 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3740 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3741 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3742 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3743 @example
3744 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3745 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3746 @}
3747 @end example
3748 @end deffn
3749
3750 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3751 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3752 and their status.
3753 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3754 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3755 but systems with a JTAG router can
3756 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3757 @end deffn
3758
3759 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3760 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3761
3762 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3763 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3764
3765 @section TAP Names
3766 @cindex dotted name
3767
3768 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3769 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3770 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3771 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3772 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3773 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3774 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3775 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3776
3777 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3778 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3779 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3780
3781 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3782
3783 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3784 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3785 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3786 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3787
3788 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3789 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3790 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3791 overridable.
3792
3793 @cindex TAP naming convention
3794 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3795 and should follow this convention:
3796
3797 @itemize @bullet
3798 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3799 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3800 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3801 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3802 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3803 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3804 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3805 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3806 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3807 with a single TAP;
3808 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3809 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3810 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3811 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3812 @end itemize
3813
3814 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3815
3816 @itemize @bullet
3817 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3818 @*The length in bits of the
3819 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3820 @end itemize
3821
3822 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3823
3824 @itemize @bullet
3825 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3826 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3827 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3828 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3829 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3830 (the TAP is linked in).
3831 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3832 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3833 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3834 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3835 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3836 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3837 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3838 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3839 values that were found but not included in the list.
3840
3841 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3842 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3843 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3844 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3845 hardware to find these values.
3846 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3847 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3848 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3849 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3850 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3851 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3852 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3853 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3854 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3855 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3856 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3857 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3858 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3859 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3860 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3861 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3862 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3863 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3864 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3865 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3866 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
3867 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
3868 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
3869 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
3870 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
3871 @end itemize
3872 @end deffn
3873
3874 @section Other TAP commands
3875
3876 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3877 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3878 At this writing this TAP attribute
3879 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3880 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3881 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3882 See the next section for information about the available events.
3883
3884 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3885 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3886 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3887 @end deffn
3888
3889 @section TAP Events
3890 @cindex events
3891 @cindex TAP events
3892
3893 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3894 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3895 The other applies to debugger targets,
3896 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3897
3898 The TAP events currently defined are:
3899
3900 @itemize @bullet
3901 @item @b{post-reset}
3902 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3903 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3904 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3905 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3906 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3907
3908 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3909 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3910 of any particular target.
3911 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3912 @item @b{setup}
3913 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3914 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3915 @item @b{tap-disable}
3916 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3917 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3918 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3919 @item @b{tap-enable}
3920 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3921 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3922 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3923 @end itemize
3924
3925 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3926 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3927 contents to be accurate), you might:
3928
3929 @example
3930 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3931 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3932 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3933 @}
3934 @end example
3935
3936
3937 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3938 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3939 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3940 @cindex jrc
3941
3942 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3943 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3944 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3945 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3946 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3947
3948 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3949 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3950 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3951 be visible.
3952 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3953 ignores, such as:
3954
3955 @itemize
3956 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3957 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3958 TAPs receive new instructions.
3959 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3960 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3961 @end itemize
3962
3963 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3964 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3965 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3966 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3967
3968 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3969 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3970
3971 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3972 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3973 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3974 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3975 should define TAP event handlers using
3976 code that looks something like this:
3977
3978 @example
3979 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3980 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3981 @}
3982 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
3983 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3984 @}
3985 @end example
3986
3987 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
3988
3989 @example
3990 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
3991 @end example
3992
3993 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
3994 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
3995 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
3996 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
3997
3998 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
3999 If necessary, disables the tap
4000 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4001 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4002 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4003 and "0" if it is disabled.
4004 @end deffn
4005
4006 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4007 If necessary, enables the tap
4008 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4009 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4010 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4011 and "0" if it is disabled.
4012 @end deffn
4013
4014 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4015 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4016 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4017 and "0" if it is disabled.
4018
4019 @quotation Note
4020 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4021 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4022 @end quotation
4023 @end deffn
4024
4025 @anchor{autoprobing}
4026 @section Autoprobing
4027 @cindex autoprobe
4028 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4029
4030 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4031 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4032 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4033 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4034
4035 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4036 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4037 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4038 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4039 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4040 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4041 right when they come out of reset).
4042
4043 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4044
4045 @example
4046 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4047 reset_config trst_and_srst
4048 jtag_rclk 8
4049 @end example
4050
4051 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4052 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4053
4054 @enumerate
4055 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4056 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4057 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4058 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4059 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4060 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4061 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4062 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4063 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4064 that is discovered.
4065 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4066 register, it will report it.
4067 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4068 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4069 @end enumerate
4070
4071 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4072 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4073 that's a bit more complex:
4074
4075 @example
4076 clock speed 8 kHz
4077 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4078 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4079 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4080 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4081 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4082 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4083 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4084 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4085 @end example
4086
4087 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4088 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4089 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4090 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4091 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4092 and so forth.
4093
4094 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4095 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4096 @cindex DAP declaration
4097
4098 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4099 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4100 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4101 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4102 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4103
4104 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4105
4106 @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4107 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4108 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4109 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4110 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4111
4112 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4113
4114 @itemize @bullet
4115 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4116 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4117 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4118 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4119 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4120 @end itemize
4121 @end deffn
4122
4123 @deffn Command {dap names}
4124 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4125 for TCL scripting.
4126 @end deffn
4127
4128 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
4129 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4130 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4131 @end deffn
4132
4133 @deffn Command {dap init}
4134 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4135 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4136 initialization, too.
4137 @end deffn
4138
4139 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4140
4141 @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
4142 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4143 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4144 @end deffn
4145
4146 @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
4147 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4148 @end deffn
4149
4150 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4151 @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4152 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4153 or set a new value @var{value}.
4154 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4155 @end deffn
4156
4157 @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4158 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4159 @end deffn
4160
4161 @deffn Command {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4162 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4163 value @var{value}.
4164
4165 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4166 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4167 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4168
4169 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4170 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4171 @end deffn
4172
4173 @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4174 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4175 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4176 @end deffn
4177
4178 @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4179 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4180 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4181 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4182 @end deffn
4183
4184 @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4185 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4186
4187 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4188 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4189 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4190 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4191 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4192 for details.
4193
4194 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4195 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4196 the pattern:
4197 @example
4198 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4199 @end example
4200
4201 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4202 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4203 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4204 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4205 @example
4206 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4207 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4208 @end example
4209
4210 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4211 @example
4212 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4213 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4214 @end example
4215
4216 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4217 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4218
4219 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4220 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4221 example with a proper dap name:
4222 @example
4223 xxx.dap apcsw default
4224 @end example
4225 @end deffn
4226
4227 @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4228 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4229 Disabled by default
4230 @end deffn
4231
4232
4233 @node CPU Configuration
4234 @chapter CPU Configuration
4235 @cindex GDB target
4236
4237 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4238 You can also access these targets without GDB
4239 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4240 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4241 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4242 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4243
4244 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4245 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4246
4247 @section Target List
4248 @cindex target, current
4249 @cindex target, list
4250
4251 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4252 where each member has a name.
4253 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4254 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4255 (plural!) command.
4256 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4257 look like with more than one:
4258 @verbatim
4259 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4260 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4261 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4262 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4263 @end verbatim
4264
4265 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4266 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4267 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4268 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4269 space seen by that current target.
4270 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4271 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4272 are examples; and there are many more.
4273
4274 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4275
4276 @deffn Command {target current}
4277 Returns the name of the current target.
4278 @end deffn
4279
4280 @deffn Command {target names}
4281 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4282 @example
4283 foreach t [target names] @{
4284 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4285 @}
4286 @end example
4287 @end deffn
4288
4289 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4290 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4291
4292 @deffn Command targets [name]
4293 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4294 command names are singular.}
4295
4296 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4297 targets in a user friendly form.
4298
4299 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4300 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4301 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4302 @end deffn
4303
4304 @section Target CPU Types
4305 @cindex target type
4306 @cindex CPU type
4307
4308 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4309 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4310 when calling @command{target create}.
4311 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4312 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4313 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4314 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4315 what core-specific commands may be available
4316 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4317 and more.
4318
4319 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4320 since there's a command to list them.
4321
4322 @anchor{targettypes}
4323 @deffn Command {target types}
4324 Lists all supported target types.
4325 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4326
4327 @itemize @bullet
4328 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
4329 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4330 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4331 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4332 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
4333 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4334 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4335 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4336 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4337 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4338 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4339 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4340 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU
4341 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4342 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4343 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4344 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4345 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4346 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4347 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4348 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4349 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4350 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4351 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4352 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4353 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4354 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4355 @itemize @minus
4356 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
4357 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4358 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4359 @end itemize
4360 And two debug interfaces cores:
4361 @itemize @minus
4362 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
4363 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
4364 @end itemize
4365 @end itemize
4366 @end deffn
4367
4368 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4369 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4370 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4371 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4372 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4373 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4374 reflect design generations;
4375 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4376 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4377
4378 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4379 @section Target Configuration
4380
4381 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4382 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4383 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4384 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4385 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4386
4387 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4388 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4389 optional parts.
4390 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4391 command, created as part of target creation.
4392
4393 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4394 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4395 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4396 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4397 to be much more board-specific.
4398 The key steps you use might look something like this
4399
4400 @example
4401 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4402 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4403 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4404 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4405 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4406 @end example
4407
4408 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4409 on-chip SRAM.
4410 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4411 writes to target memory;
4412 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4413 GDB memory checksumming;
4414 and more.
4415
4416 @quotation Warning
4417 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4418 inaccessible when application code
4419 (such as an operating system)
4420 enables or disables the MMU.
4421 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4422 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4423 easy access to other addresses needed.
4424 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4425 @end quotation
4426
4427 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4428 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4429 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4430 controllers.
4431 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4432 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4433 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4434
4435 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4436 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4437 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4438 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4439 purposes including additional configuration.
4440
4441 @itemize @bullet
4442 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4443 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4444 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4445 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4446
4447 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4448 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4449 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4450 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4451 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4452 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4453 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4454
4455 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4456 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4457 @end itemize
4458 @end deffn
4459
4460 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4461 The options accepted by this command may also be
4462 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4463 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4464 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4465
4466 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4467 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4468 and changing its endianness.
4469
4470 @itemize @bullet
4471
4472 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4473 used to access this target.
4474
4475 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4476 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4477 create and manage DAP instances.
4478
4479 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4480 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4481
4482 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4483 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4484 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4485 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4486 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4487 same event name assigns only one handler.
4488
4489 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4490 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4491
4492 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4493 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4494 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4495 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4496 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4497 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4498 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4499
4500 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4501 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4502 or virtual address is being used.
4503
4504 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4505 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4506
4507 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4508 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4509 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4510 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4511 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4512
4513 @anchor{rtostype}
4514 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4515 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4516 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4517 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx}
4518 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4519
4520 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4521 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4522 access the target for debugging.
4523
4524 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4525 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4526 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4527 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4528
4529 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4530 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4531 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4532 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4533 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4534
4535 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4536 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4537 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4538 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4539 command @command{gdb_port}.
4540 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4541 @end itemize
4542 @end deffn
4543
4544 @section Other $target_name Commands
4545 @cindex object command
4546
4547 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4548 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4549
4550 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4551 Once a button is created a button
4552 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4553 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4554 configure it like this:
4555
4556 @example
4557 # Create
4558 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4559 # Modify
4560 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4561 # Query
4562 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4563 # Report
4564 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4565 @end example
4566
4567 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4568 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4569
4570 @example
4571 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4572 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4573 @end example
4574
4575 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4576
4577 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4578 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4579 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4580 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4581 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4582 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4583 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4584 They are not otherwise documented here.
4585 @end deffn
4586
4587 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4588 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4589 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4590 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4591 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4592 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4593 the target side uses raw memory.
4594
4595 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4596 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4597 The script orientation comes from working with data
4598 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4599 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4600 and neither store nor return those values.
4601
4602 @itemize
4603 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4604 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4605 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4606 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4607 @end itemize
4608 @end deffn
4609
4610 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4611 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4612 @command{$target_name configure}
4613 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4614 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4615 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4616 There are a few special cases:
4617
4618 @itemize @bullet
4619 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4620 event named @var{event_name}.
4621 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4622 two parameters.
4623 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4624 This is a special case because this is set using
4625 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4626 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4627 @end itemize
4628
4629 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4630 all the targets you might use something like this:
4631
4632 @example
4633 foreach name [target names] @{
4634 set y [$name cget -endian]
4635 set z [$name cget -type]
4636 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4637 $x $name $y $z]
4638 @}
4639 @end example
4640 @end deffn
4641
4642 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4643 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4644 Displays the current target state:
4645 @code{debug-running},
4646 @code{halted},
4647 @code{reset},
4648 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4649 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4650 @end deffn
4651
4652 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4653 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4654 currently associated with this target.
4655 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4656 @end deffn
4657
4658 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4659 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4660 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4661 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4662 @end deffn
4663
4664 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4665 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4666 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4667 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4668 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4669 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4670 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4671 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4672 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4673 @end deffn
4674
4675 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4676 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4677 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4678 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4679 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4680 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4681 @end deffn
4682
4683 @anchor{targetevents}
4684 @section Target Events
4685 @cindex target events
4686 @cindex events
4687 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4688 For example:
4689 @itemize @bullet
4690 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4691 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4692 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4693 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4694 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4695 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4696 to set up system clocks or
4697 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4698 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4699 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4700 @end itemize
4701
4702 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4703 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4704 @command{target create ... -event}.
4705
4706 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4707 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4708 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4709
4710 @example
4711 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4712 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4713 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4714 @}
4715 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4716 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4717 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4718 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4719 @}
4720 @end example
4721
4722 The following target events are defined:
4723
4724 @itemize @bullet
4725 @item @b{debug-halted}
4726 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4727 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4728 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4729 @item @b{early-halted}
4730 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4731 @item @b{examine-start}
4732 @* Before target examine is called.
4733 @item @b{examine-end}
4734 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4735 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4736 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4737 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4738 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4739 connect GDB to running target.
4740 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4741 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4742 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4743 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4744 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4745 is in RAM or read only memory.
4746 Default is @code{halt}
4747 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4748 @* When GDB disconnects
4749 @item @b{gdb-end}
4750 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4751 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4752 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4753 @code{reset init})
4754 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4755 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4756 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4757 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4758 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4759 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4760 @item @b{gdb-start}
4761 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4762 @item @b{halted}
4763 @* The target has halted
4764 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4765 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4766 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4767 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4768 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4769 @item @b{reset-assert}
4770 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4771 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4772 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4773 it instead of asserting SRST.
4774 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4775 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4776 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4777 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4778 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4779 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4780 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4781 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4782 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4783 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4784 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4785 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4786 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4787 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4788 released on the scan chain.
4789 @item @b{reset-end}
4790 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4791 @item @b{reset-init}
4792 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4793 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4794
4795 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4796 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4797 multiplexing, and so on.
4798 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4799 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4800 @item @b{reset-start}
4801 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
4802 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
4803
4804 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4805 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4806 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4807 @item @b{resume-start}
4808 @* Before any target is resumed
4809 @item @b{resume-end}
4810 @* After all targets have resumed
4811 @item @b{resumed}
4812 @* Target has resumed
4813 @item @b{trace-config}
4814 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4815 @end itemize
4816
4817 @node Flash Commands
4818 @chapter Flash Commands
4819
4820 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4821 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4822 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4823 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4824 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4825 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4826 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4827 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4828 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4829
4830 Flash Steps:
4831 @enumerate
4832 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4833 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4834 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4835 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4836 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4837 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4838 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4839 @item GDB Flashing
4840 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4841 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4842 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4843 @end enumerate
4844
4845 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4846 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4847 so that it can't boot.
4848 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4849 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4850
4851 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4852 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4853 @cindex flash configuration
4854
4855 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4856 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4857 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4858 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4859 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4860 see the driver-specific documentation.
4861
4862 @itemize @bullet
4863 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4864 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4865 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4866 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4867 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4868 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4869 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4870 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4871 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4872 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4873 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4874 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4875 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4876 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4877 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4878 commands to the flash controller.
4879 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4880 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4881 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4882 for more information.
4883 @end itemize
4884 @quotation Note
4885 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4886 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4887 @end quotation
4888 @end deffn
4889
4890 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4891 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4892 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4893 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4894 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4895 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4896 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4897 @end deffn
4898
4899 @deffn Command {flash list}
4900 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4901 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4902 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4903 @end deffn
4904
4905 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4906 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4907 depends on the flash type.
4908 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4909 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4910 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4911 but most don't bother.
4912 @end deffn
4913
4914 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4915 @cindex flash erasing
4916 @cindex flash reading
4917 @cindex flash writing
4918 @cindex flash programming
4919 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4920
4921 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4922 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
4923 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4924 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4925 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4926
4927 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4928 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4929 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4930 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4931 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4932
4933 @quotation Note
4934 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4935 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4936 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4937 back to a flash bank.
4938 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4939 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4940 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4941 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4942 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4943 @end quotation
4944
4945 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4946 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4947 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4948 disabled first.
4949 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4950 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4951 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4952
4953 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4954 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4955 up to and including @var{last}.
4956 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4957 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4958 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4959 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4960 @end deffn
4961
4962 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4963 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4964 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4965 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4966 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4967 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4968 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4969 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4970 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4971 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4972 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4973 before erase starts.
4974 @end deffn
4975
4976 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4977 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4978 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4979 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4980 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4981 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4982 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
4983 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
4984 before issuing this command.
4985 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
4986 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
4987 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
4988 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
4989 @end deffn
4990 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
4991
4992 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
4993 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
4994 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
4995 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
4996 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4997 @end deffn
4998
4999 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5000 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5001 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5002 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5003 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5004 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5005 @end deffn
5006
5007 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5008 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5009 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5010 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5011 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5012 @end deffn
5013
5014 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5015 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5016 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5017 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5018 to the base address for each section in the image.
5019 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5020 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5021 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5022 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5023 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5024 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5025 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5026 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5027 each image section.
5028
5029 @quotation Warning
5030 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5031 data you want to preserve.
5032 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5033 sections might be erased with no notice.
5034 @itemize
5035 @item
5036 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5037 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5038 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5039 @item
5040 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5041 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5042 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5043 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5044 @end itemize
5045 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5046 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5047 @end quotation
5048
5049 @end deffn
5050
5051 @section Other Flash commands
5052 @cindex flash protection
5053
5054 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
5055 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5056 and display that status.
5057 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5058 @end deffn
5059
5060 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
5061 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5062 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5063
5064 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5065 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5066 and possibly stale information.
5067 @end deffn
5068
5069 @anchor{flashprotect}
5070 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5071 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5072 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5073 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5074 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5075 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5076 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5077 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5078 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5079 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5080 @end deffn
5081
5082 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
5083 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5084 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5085 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5086 @end deffn
5087
5088 @anchor{program}
5089 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5090 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5091 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5092 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5093 @end deffn
5094
5095 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5096 @section Flash Driver List
5097 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5098 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5099 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5100
5101 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5102 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5103 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5104
5105 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5106
5107 @itemize
5108 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5109 @end itemize
5110
5111 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5112 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5113 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5114 @example
5115 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5116 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5117 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5118 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5119 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5120 @end example
5121 @end deffn
5122
5123 @subsection External Flash
5124
5125 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
5126 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5127 @cindex CFI
5128 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5129 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5130 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5131 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5132 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5133 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5134 configure a bus and its timings), or
5135 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5136 on the flash chip.
5137 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5138 speed up operation.
5139
5140 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5141
5142 @itemize
5143 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5144 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5145 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5146 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5147 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5148 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5149 @end itemize
5150
5151 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5152 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5153
5154 @example
5155 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5156 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5157 @end example
5158
5159 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5160 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5161 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5162
5163 @example
5164 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5165 @end example
5166
5167 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5168 @end deffn
5169
5170 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5171 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5172 @cindex SPI
5173 @cindex jtagspi
5174 @cindex bscan_spi
5175 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5176 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5177 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5178 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5179 accessed through JTAG.
5180
5181 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5182 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5183 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5184 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5185 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5186 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5187
5188 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5189 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5190 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5191 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5192 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5193 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5194 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5195 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5196
5197 @itemize
5198 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5199 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5200 @var{USER1} instruction.
5201 @end itemize
5202
5203 @example
5204 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5205 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5206 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5207 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5208 @end example
5209 @end deffn
5210
5211 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5212 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5213 @cindex xcf
5214 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5215 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5216 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5217 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5218 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5219
5220 @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5221 command accepts additional parameters:
5222 @itemize
5223 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5224 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5225 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5226 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5227 in master mode.
5228 @end itemize
5229 @example
5230 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5231 @end example
5232 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5233 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5234 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5235 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5236 dedicated sector.
5237 @end deffn
5238
5239 @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5240 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5241 button.
5242 @example
5243 xcf configure 0
5244 @end example
5245 @end deffn
5246
5247 Additional driver notes:
5248 @itemize
5249 @item Only single revision supported.
5250 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5251 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5252 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5253 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5254 @end itemize
5255 @end deffn
5256
5257 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5258 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5259 @cindex SPIFI
5260 @cindex lpcspifi
5261 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5262 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5263 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5264
5265 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5266 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5267 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5268 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5269 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5270
5271 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5272 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5273 are configured by the driver.
5274
5275 @example
5276 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5277 @end example
5278
5279 @end deffn
5280
5281 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5282 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5283 @cindex SMI
5284 @cindex stmsmi
5285 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5286 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5287 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5288 SPI flash devices.
5289 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5290 flash devices can be connected.
5291
5292 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5293 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5294 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5295 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5296 the flash content.
5297
5298 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5299 to identify the memory bank.
5300 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5301 flash size, are detected automatically.
5302
5303 @example
5304 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5305 @end example
5306
5307 @end deffn
5308
5309 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5310 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5311 Microcontroller platform.
5312
5313 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5314 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5315
5316 @example
5317 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5318 @end example
5319
5320 @end deffn
5321
5322 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5323 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5324 @cindex ath79
5325 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5326 chip selects.
5327 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5328 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5329 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5330 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5331 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5332 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5333
5334 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5335 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5336 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5337 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5338 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5339 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5340 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5341 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5342 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5343 with the default CS0.
5344 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5345 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5346 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5347
5348 @example
5349 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5350
5351 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different for each,
5352 # otherwise the write_image command is not able to distinguish the
5353 # banks.
5354 flash bank flash0 ath79 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5355 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5356 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5357 @end example
5358
5359 @end deffn
5360
5361 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5362
5363 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5364 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5365 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5366 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5367 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5368 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5369
5370 @example
5371 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5372 @end example
5373 @end deffn
5374
5375 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5376 @cindex ambiqmicro
5377 @cindex apollo
5378 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5379 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5380 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5381 with the target using SWD.
5382
5383 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5384 the device class of the MCU.
5385 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5386 to set up the flash banks.
5387 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5388 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5389
5390 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5391 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5392 and the second bank starts after the first.
5393
5394 @example
5395 # Flash bank 0
5396 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5397 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5398 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5399 $_TARGETNAME
5400 @end example
5401
5402 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5403 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5404 are available to the user.
5405
5406 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5407
5408 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5409 Erase entire bank.
5410 @end deffn
5411 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5412 Erase device pages.
5413 @end deffn
5414 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5415 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5416 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5417 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5418 the flash.
5419 @end deffn
5420 @end deffn
5421
5422 @anchor{at91samd}
5423 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5424 @cindex at91samd
5425 All members of the ATSAMD, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5426 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5427 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5428
5429 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5430 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5431 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5432 processor to be halted.
5433 @end deffn
5434
5435 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5436 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5437 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5438 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5439 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5440 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5441
5442 @example
5443 at91samd set-security enable
5444 @end example
5445 @end deffn
5446
5447 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5448 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5449 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5450 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5451 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5452 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5453 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5454 in order to disable this feature.
5455
5456 @example
5457 at91samd eeprom
5458 at91samd eeprom 1024
5459 @end example
5460 @end deffn
5461
5462 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5463 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5464 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5465 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5466 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5467 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5468
5469 @example
5470 at91samd bootloader
5471 at91samd bootloader 16384
5472 @end example
5473 @end deffn
5474
5475 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5476 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5477 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5478 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5479 @end deffn
5480
5481 @deffn Command {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5482 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5483 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5484 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5485 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5486 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5487 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5488 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5489
5490 @example
5491 # Read user row
5492 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5493 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5494 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5495 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5496 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low byte unchanged
5497 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5498 @end example
5499 @end deffn
5500
5501 @end deffn
5502
5503 @anchor{at91sam3}
5504 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5505 @cindex at91sam3
5506 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5507 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5508 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5509 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5510 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5511 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5512 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5513 chips are confirmed.}
5514
5515 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5516 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5517 the following fixed locations:
5518
5519 @example
5520 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5521 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5522 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5523 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5524 @end example
5525
5526 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5527 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5528 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5529
5530 @itemize
5531 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5532 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5533 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5534 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5535 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5536 @end itemize
5537
5538 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5539
5540 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5541 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5542 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5543 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5544 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5545 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5546 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5547
5548 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5549 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5550 @end deffn
5551
5552 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5553 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5554 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5555 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5556 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5557 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5558 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5559 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5560 @end deffn
5561
5562 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5563 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5564 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5565 @end deffn
5566 @end deffn
5567
5568 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5569 @cindex at91sam4
5570 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5571 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5572 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5573 @end deffn
5574
5575 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5576 @cindex at91sam4l
5577 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5578 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5579 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5580
5581 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5582 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5583 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5584 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5585 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5586 @end deffn
5587 @end deffn
5588
5589 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5590 @cindex atsamv
5591 All members of the ATSAMV, ATSAMS, and ATSAME families from
5592 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5593 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5594 @end deffn
5595
5596 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5597 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5598 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5599 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5600 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5601
5602 @example
5603 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5604 @end example
5605
5606 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5607 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5608
5609 @itemize
5610 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5611 @item @var{banks}
5612 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5613 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5614 @item @var{pages_size}
5615 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5616 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5617 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5618 @end itemize
5619
5620 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5621 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5622 will be autoconfigured.
5623 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5624
5625 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5626 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5627 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5628 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5629 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5630
5631 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5632 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5633 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5634 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5635 are not truly general purpose).
5636 @quotation Note
5637 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5638 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5639 @end quotation
5640 @end deffn
5641 @end deffn
5642
5643 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5644 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5645 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5646 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5647 @end deffn
5648
5649 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
5650 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1 and BlueNRG-2 Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0 core and internal flash memory.
5651 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
5652 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
5653
5654 @example
5655 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5656 @end example
5657
5658 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
5659 each single sector one by one.
5660
5661 @example
5662 flash erase_sector 0 0 79 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-1
5663 @end example
5664
5665 @example
5666 flash erase_sector 0 0 127 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-2
5667 @end example
5668
5669 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
5670 @end deffn
5671
5672 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc26xx
5673 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
5674 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
5675 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
5676 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
5677 starts at address 0.
5678
5679 @example
5680 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5681 @end example
5682 @end deffn
5683
5684 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc3220sf
5685 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
5686 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
5687 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
5688 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
5689 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
5690 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
5691 and programming the serial flash.
5692
5693 @example
5694 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5695 @end example
5696 @end deffn
5697
5698 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5699 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5700 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5701 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5702 autoconfigures itself.
5703 @example
5704 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5705 @end example
5706 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5707 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5708 this via the following command:
5709 @example
5710 efm32 debuglock num
5711 @end example
5712 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5713 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5714 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5715 supported.}
5716 @end deffn
5717
5718 @deffn {Flash Driver} esirisc
5719 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
5720 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
5721 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
5722 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
5723 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
5724
5725 @example
5726 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
5727 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
5728 @end example
5729
5730 @deffn Command {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
5731 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
5732 @end deffn
5733
5734 @deffn Command {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
5735 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
5736 is an uncommon operation.}
5737 @end deffn
5738 @end deffn
5739
5740 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5741 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5742 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
5743 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5744 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5745 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5746 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5747
5748 @example
5749 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5750 @end example
5751 @end deffn
5752
5753 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
5754 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
5755 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
5756 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
5757 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5758 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
5759 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
5760 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
5761 characters) ignored.
5762
5763 @example
5764 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
5765 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5766 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
5767 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5768 @end example
5769 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
5770 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
5771 @end deffn
5772
5773 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
5774 @cindex kinetis
5775 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
5776 from NXP (former Freescale) include
5777 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
5778 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
5779 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5780 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
5781
5782 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
5783 @itemize
5784 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
5785 @end itemize
5786
5787 @example
5788 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5789 @end example
5790
5791 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
5792 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
5793 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
5794 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
5795 @end deffn
5796
5797 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
5798 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
5799 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
5800 set by 'flash protect' command.
5801 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
5802 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
5803 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
5804 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
5805 with the rest of a flash image.
5806 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
5807 @end deffn
5808
5809 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
5810 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
5811 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
5812 @end deffn
5813
5814 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
5815 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5816 @end deffn
5817
5818 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
5819 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
5820 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
5821 @end deffn
5822
5823 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
5824 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
5825 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
5826 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
5827 command completes.
5828 @end deffn
5829
5830 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
5831 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
5832 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
5833 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
5834 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
5835
5836 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
5837 Program Partition command.
5838
5839 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
5840 Reset the device after partition setting.
5841
5842 Show partition size:
5843 @example
5844 kinetis nvm_partition info
5845 @end example
5846
5847 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
5848 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5849 @example
5850 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
5851 @end example
5852
5853 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
5854 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5855 @example
5856 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
5857 @end example
5858 @end deffn
5859
5860 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
5861 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
5862 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
5863 @end deffn
5864
5865 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
5866 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
5867 Command disables watchdog timer.
5868 @end deffn
5869 @end deffn
5870
5871 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
5872 @cindex kinetis_ke
5873 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
5874 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
5875 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
5876 autoconfigures itself.
5877 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
5878
5879 @example
5880 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5881 @end example
5882
5883 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
5884 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5885 @end deffn
5886
5887 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
5888 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
5889 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
5890 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
5891 It does not require the processor to be halted.
5892 @end deffn
5893
5894 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
5895 Command disables watchdog timer.
5896 @end deffn
5897 @end deffn
5898
5899 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5900 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
5901 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
5902 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000 and LPC54100
5903 microcontroller families from NXP.
5904
5905 @quotation Note
5906 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
5907 driver:
5908 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
5909 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
5910 @end quotation
5911
5912 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and one optional parameters,
5913 which must appear in the following order:
5914
5915 @itemize
5916 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
5917 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
5918 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
5919 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
5920 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
5921 LPC43x[2357])
5922 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
5923 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
5924 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
5925 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
5926 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
5927 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
5928 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx and LPC40xx
5929 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
5930 at which the core is running
5931 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
5932 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
5933 @quotation Note
5934 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
5935 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
5936 However, if you do provide it,
5937 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
5938 @end quotation
5939 @end itemize
5940
5941 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5942
5943 @example
5944 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
5945 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
5946 @end example
5947
5948 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
5949 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
5950 the specified flash @var{bank}.
5951 @end deffn
5952 @end deffn
5953
5954 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
5955 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
5956 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
5957 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
5958 the programming clock rate in Hz.
5959 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5960
5961 @example
5962 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
5963 @end example
5964 @end deffn
5965
5966 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
5967 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
5968 from NXP.
5969
5970 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
5971 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
5972 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5973 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
5974 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
5975 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
5976 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
5977 you start the PLL.
5978
5979 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
5980
5981 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
5982 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
5983 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
5984
5985 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
5986 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
5987 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
5988 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
5989 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
5990 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
5991 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
5992
5993 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
5994 @example
5995 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
5996 @end example
5997
5998 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
5999 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6000 @code{flash banks} command.
6001
6002 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
6003 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6004 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6005 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6006 a known signature.
6007 Example:
6008 @example
6009 lpc2900 signature 0
6010 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6011 @end example
6012 @end deffn
6013
6014 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6015 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6016 saves it to a file in binary format.
6017 Example:
6018 @example
6019 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6020 @end example
6021 @end deffn
6022
6023 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6024 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6025 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6026 command:
6027
6028 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
6029 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6030 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6031 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6032
6033 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6034 Example:
6035 @example
6036 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6037 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6038 @end example
6039 @end deffn
6040
6041 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6042 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6043 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6044 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6045 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6046 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6047 912 bytes.
6048 @quotation Attention
6049 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6050 @end quotation
6051 Example:
6052 @example
6053 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6054 @end example
6055 @end deffn
6056
6057 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6058 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6059 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6060 after the next power cycle.
6061 @quotation Attention
6062 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6063 @end quotation
6064 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6065 Example:
6066 @example
6067 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6068 flash info 0
6069 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6070 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6071 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6072 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6073 @end example
6074 @end deffn
6075
6076 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6077 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6078 effective after the next power cycle.
6079 @quotation Attention
6080 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6081 @end quotation
6082 Examples:
6083 @example
6084 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6085 @end example
6086 @end deffn
6087 @end deffn
6088
6089 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
6090 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6091 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6092 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6093
6094 @example
6095 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6096 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6097 @end example
6098
6099 @itemize @bullet
6100 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6101 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6102 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6103 @end itemize
6104
6105 Example usage:
6106 @example
6107 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6108 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6109 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6110 @} else @{
6111 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6112 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6113 @}
6114 @end example
6115 @end deffn
6116
6117 @deffn {Flash Driver} msp432
6118 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6119 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6120 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6121 Main program flash (starting at address 0) is flash bank 0. Information flash
6122 region on MSP432P4 versions (starting at address 0x200000) is flash bank 1.
6123
6124 @example
6125 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6126 @end example
6127
6128 @deffn Command {msp432 mass_erase} [main|all]
6129 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6130 only the main program flash.
6131
6132 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6133 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6134 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6135 @end deffn
6136
6137 @deffn Command {msp432 bsl} [unlock|lock]
6138 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6139 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6140 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6141
6142 To erase and program the BSL:
6143 @example
6144 msp432 bsl unlock
6145 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6146 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6147 msp432 bsl lock
6148 @end example
6149 @end deffn
6150 @end deffn
6151
6152 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
6153 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6154 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6155 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6156 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6157 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6158 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6159 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6160 also have division into regions: main and info.
6161 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6162 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6163
6164 @example
6165 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6166 @end example
6167
6168 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6169
6170 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6171 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6172 @end deffn
6173
6174 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6175 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6176 @end deffn
6177
6178 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6179 Erase all userflash including info region.
6180 @end deffn
6181
6182 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6183 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6184 @end deffn
6185
6186 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6187 Check sectors protect.
6188 @end deffn
6189
6190 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6191 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6192 @end deffn
6193
6194 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6195 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6196 @end deffn
6197
6198 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6199 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6200 @end deffn
6201
6202 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6203 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6204 @end deffn
6205
6206 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6207 Show information about flash driver.
6208 @end deffn
6209
6210 @end deffn
6211
6212 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
6213 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6214 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6215 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6216 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6217
6218 @example
6219 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6220 @end example
6221
6222 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6223
6224 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
6225 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6226 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6227 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6228 code.
6229 @end deffn
6230
6231 @end deffn
6232
6233 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
6234 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6235 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6236
6237 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6238 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6239 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6240 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6241
6242 @example
6243 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6244 @end example
6245 @end deffn
6246
6247 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
6248 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6249 and integrate flash memory.
6250
6251 @example
6252 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6253 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6254 @end example
6255
6256 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6257 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6258 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6259 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6260 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6261 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6262 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6263 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6264 @end deffn
6265 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
6266 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6267 This will remove any Code Protection.
6268 @end deffn
6269 @end deffn
6270
6271 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6272 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6273 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6274 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6275 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6276
6277 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6278 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6279
6280 @example
6281 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6282 @end example
6283
6284 psoc4-specific commands
6285 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6286 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6287
6288 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6289 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6290
6291 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6292 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6293 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6294
6295 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6296 @end deffn
6297
6298 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6299 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6300
6301 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6302 @end deffn
6303 @end deffn
6304
6305 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp
6306 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6307 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6308 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6309 apart from the base address.
6310
6311 @example
6312 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6313 @end example
6314
6315 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6316 @quotation Attention
6317 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6318 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6319 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6320 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6321 @end quotation
6322
6323 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6324
6325 @deffn Command {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6326 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6327 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6328 @end deffn
6329 @end deffn
6330
6331 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_eeprom
6332 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6333 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6334 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6335 apart from the base address.
6336
6337 @example
6338 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6339 @end example
6340 @end deffn
6341
6342 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_nvl
6343 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6344 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6345 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6346
6347 @example
6348 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6349 @end example
6350
6351 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6352
6353 @itemize
6354 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6355 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6356 @end itemize
6357
6358 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6359
6360 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6361 @quotation Attention
6362 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6363 after successful write.
6364 @end quotation
6365 @end deffn
6366
6367 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6368 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6369 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6370 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6371
6372 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6373 @itemize @bullet
6374 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6375 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6376 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6377 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6378 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6379 row size: 512 bytes.
6380 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6381 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6382 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6383 operation will erase row automatically.
6384 @end itemize
6385
6386 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6387 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6388
6389 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6390
6391 @example
6392 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6393 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6394 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6395 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6396 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6397 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6398
6399 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6400 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6401 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6402 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6403 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6404 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6405 @end example
6406
6407 psoc6-specific commands
6408 @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
6409 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6410 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6411 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6412 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6413 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6414 @end deffn
6415
6416 @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6417 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6418 by @command{flash banks}.
6419 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6420 @end deffn
6421 @end deffn
6422
6423 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6424 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6425 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6426 and SWD interface.
6427 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6428 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6429
6430 @example
6431 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6432 @end example
6433
6434 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6435
6436 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
6437 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6438 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6439 @end deffn
6440
6441 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
6442 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6443 @end deffn
6444 @end deffn
6445
6446 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6447 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6448 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6449 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6450 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6451
6452 @example
6453 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6454 @end example
6455
6456 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
6457 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6458 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6459 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6460 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6461 disabled.
6462
6463 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6464 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6465 @quotation Warning
6466 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6467 applied to all of them.
6468 @end quotation
6469 @end deffn
6470 @end deffn
6471
6472 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6473 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6474 from STMicroelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6475 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6476 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6477
6478 @example
6479 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6480 @end example
6481
6482 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6483 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6484 the flash driver.
6485
6486 @example
6487 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6488 @end example
6489
6490 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6491 as per the following example.
6492 @example
6493 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6494 @end example
6495
6496 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6497
6498 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
6499 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
6500 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6501 @end deffn
6502
6503 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
6504 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
6505 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
6506 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6507 @end deffn
6508
6509 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6510 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
6511 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6512 @end deffn
6513
6514 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
6515 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
6516 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
6517 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6518 @end deffn
6519
6520 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP})
6521 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
6522 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6523 @end deffn
6524
6525 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_load} num
6526 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
6527 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
6528 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
6529 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6530 @end deffn
6531 @end deffn
6532
6533 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
6534 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6535 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
6536 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6537 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6538
6539 @example
6540 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6541 @end example
6542
6543 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6544 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6545 the flash driver.
6546
6547 @example
6548 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6549 @end example
6550
6551 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
6552
6553 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
6554 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6555 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6556 @end deffn
6557
6558 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
6559 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6560 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6561 @end deffn
6562
6563 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
6564 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
6565 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6566 @end deffn
6567
6568 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
6569 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
6570 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6571 @end deffn
6572
6573 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
6574 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
6575 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
6576 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
6577 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
6578 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
6579 @end deffn
6580
6581 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
6582 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
6583 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
6584 @end deffn
6585 @end deffn
6586
6587 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
6588 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6589 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
6590 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6591 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6592
6593 @example
6594 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6595 @end example
6596
6597 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6598 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6599 the flash driver.
6600
6601 @example
6602 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6603 @end example
6604
6605 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
6606
6607 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
6608 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6609 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6610 @end deffn
6611
6612 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
6613 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6614 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6615 @end deffn
6616
6617 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
6618 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
6619 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6620 @end deffn
6621 @end deffn
6622
6623 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
6624 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6625 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
6626 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6627 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6628
6629 @example
6630 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6631 @end example
6632
6633 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6634 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6635 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
6636 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
6637 second bank.
6638
6639 @example
6640 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6641 @end example
6642
6643 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
6644
6645 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
6646 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6647 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6648 @end deffn
6649
6650 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
6651 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6652 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6653 @end deffn
6654
6655 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
6656 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
6657 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
6658 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
6659 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6660 @end deffn
6661 @end deffn
6662
6663 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
6664 All members of the STM32L4 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6665 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6666 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6667 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6668
6669 @example
6670 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6671 @end example
6672
6673 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6674 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6675 the flash driver.
6676
6677 @example
6678 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6679 @end example
6680
6681 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
6682
6683 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
6684 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6685 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6686 @end deffn
6687
6688 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
6689 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6690 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6691 @end deffn
6692
6693 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
6694 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
6695 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6696 @end deffn
6697
6698 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
6699 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
6700 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6701 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
6702
6703 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
6704 @example
6705 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
6706 # Option Register: <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
6707 @end example
6708
6709 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
6710 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
6711 @end deffn
6712
6713 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
6714 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
6715 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6716 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
6717 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
6718
6719 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
6720 @example
6721 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
6722 @end example
6723
6724 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
6725 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
6726 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
6727 @end deffn
6728
6729 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_load} num
6730 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a reset of the device.
6731 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6732 @end deffn
6733 @end deffn
6734
6735 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
6736 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
6737 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6738 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
6739 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
6740
6741 @example
6742 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
6743 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
6744 @end example
6745
6746 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
6747 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
6748 for the specified flash bank.
6749 @end deffn
6750 @end deffn
6751
6752 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
6753 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
6754 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
6755 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
6756 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
6757
6758 @example
6759 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6760 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
6761 @end example
6762
6763 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
6764 Configures the str9 flash controller.
6765 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6766
6767 @itemize @bullet
6768 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
6769 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
6770 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6771 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6772 @end itemize
6773 @end deffn
6774
6775 @end deffn
6776
6777 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
6778 @cindex str9xpec
6779
6780 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
6781 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
6782 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
6783 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
6784
6785 Here is some background info to help
6786 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
6787 the str9:
6788 @enumerate
6789 @item
6790 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
6791 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
6792 @item
6793 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
6794 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
6795 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
6796 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
6797 @end enumerate
6798
6799 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
6800 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
6801 configured for flash bank 0.
6802 @example
6803 # assert srst, we do not want core running
6804 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
6805 jtag_reset 0 1
6806 # turn off target polling
6807 poll off
6808 # disable str9 core
6809 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
6810 # read option bytes
6811 str9xpec options_read 0
6812 # re-enable str9 core
6813 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
6814 poll on
6815 reset halt
6816 @end example
6817 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
6818 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
6819 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
6820 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
6821
6822 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
6823
6824 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
6825 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
6826 @end deffn
6827
6828 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
6829 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
6830 directly to the embedded flash controller.
6831 @end deffn
6832
6833 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
6834 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
6835 erase the device.
6836 @end deffn
6837
6838 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
6839 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
6840 @end deffn
6841
6842 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
6843 Configure str9 boot bank.
6844 @end deffn
6845
6846 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6847 Configure str9 lvd source.
6848 @end deffn
6849
6850 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
6851 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
6852 @end deffn
6853
6854 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6855 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
6856 @end deffn
6857
6858 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
6859 Read str9 option bytes.
6860 @end deffn
6861
6862 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
6863 Write str9 option bytes.
6864 @end deffn
6865
6866 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
6867 unlock str9 device.
6868 @end deffn
6869
6870 @end deffn
6871
6872 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
6873 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
6874 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6875 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6876
6877 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
6878
6879 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
6880 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
6881 @end deffn
6882
6883 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
6884 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
6885 @end deffn
6886
6887 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
6888 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
6889 the flash clock.
6890 @end deffn
6891 @end deffn
6892
6893 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
6894 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6895 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6896 @end deffn
6897
6898 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
6899 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6900 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6901
6902 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
6903
6904 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
6905 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
6906 @end deffn
6907
6908 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
6909 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
6910 @end deffn
6911
6912 @end deffn
6913
6914 @section NAND Flash Commands
6915 @cindex NAND
6916
6917 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
6918 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
6919 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
6920
6921 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
6922 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
6923 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
6924 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
6925 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
6926 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
6927
6928 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
6929 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
6930 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
6931 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
6932 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
6933 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
6934 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
6935 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
6936 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
6937 with techniques such as wear leveling.
6938
6939 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
6940 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
6941 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
6942 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
6943 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
6944 every 512 bytes of data.
6945
6946 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
6947 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
6948 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
6949 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
6950 ECC mode is used.
6951
6952 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
6953 @enumerate
6954 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
6955 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
6956 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
6957 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
6958 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
6959 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
6960 to access that device.
6961 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
6962 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
6963 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
6964 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
6965 de-brick a board.
6966 @end enumerate
6967
6968 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
6969 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
6970 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
6971 are only 32 bits wide.
6972 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
6973 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
6974 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
6975 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
6976
6977 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
6978 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
6979 @cindex NAND configuration
6980
6981 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
6982 plus some additional configuration that's done after
6983 OpenOCD has initialized.
6984
6985 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
6986 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
6987 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
6988 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
6989 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
6990 they were a single (larger) device.
6991 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
6992 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
6993
6994 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
6995 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
6996 configuration files, not interactively.
6997
6998 @itemize @bullet
6999 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7000 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7001 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7002 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7003 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7004 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7005 commands to the NAND controller.
7006 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7007 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7008 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7009 for more information.
7010 @end itemize
7011 @end deffn
7012
7013 @deffn Command {nand list}
7014 Prints a summary of each device declared
7015 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7016 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7017 @example
7018 > nand list
7019 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7020 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7021 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7022 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7023 >
7024 @end example
7025 @end deffn
7026
7027 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
7028 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7029 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7030 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7031 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7032 it with most other NAND commands.
7033 @end deffn
7034
7035 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7036
7037 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7038 @cindex NAND reading
7039 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7040 starting at the specified offset.
7041 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7042
7043 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7044 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7045
7046 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7047 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7048 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7049
7050 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7051 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7052 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7053 method which handled that error correction.
7054
7055 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7056 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7057 @itemize @bullet
7058 @item no oob_* parameter
7059 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7060 @item @code{oob_raw}
7061 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7062 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7063 spare areas associated with each data page.
7064 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7065 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7066 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7067 @item @code{oob_only}
7068 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7069 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7070 spare areas associated with each data page.
7071 @end itemize
7072 @end deffn
7073
7074 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
7075 @cindex NAND erasing
7076 @cindex NAND programming
7077 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7078 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7079 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7080 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7081 If those parameters are not specified,
7082 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7083 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7084
7085 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7086 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7087 block marker.
7088 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7089 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7090 @end deffn
7091
7092 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7093 @cindex NAND writing
7094 @cindex NAND programming
7095 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7096 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7097 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7098 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7099
7100 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7101 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7102
7103 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7104 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7105 past the end of the device.
7106 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7107 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7108 if that's being written.)
7109
7110 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7111 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7112 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7113
7114 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7115 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7116 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7117 @itemize @bullet
7118 @item no oob_* parameter
7119 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7120 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7121 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7122 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7123 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7124 @item @code{oob_only}
7125 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7126 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7127 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7128 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7129 @item @code{oob_raw}
7130 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7131 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7132 un-altered OOB.
7133 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7134 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7135 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7136 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7137 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7138 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7139 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7140 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7141 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7142 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7143 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7144 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7145 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7146 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7147 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7148 @end itemize
7149 @end deffn
7150
7151 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7152 @cindex NAND verification
7153 @cindex NAND programming
7154 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7155 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7156 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7157
7158 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7159 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7160
7161 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7162 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7163 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7164 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7165 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7166
7167 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7168 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7169 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7170
7171 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7172 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7173 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7174 be removed in a future release.
7175 @end deffn
7176
7177 @subsection Other NAND commands
7178 @cindex NAND other commands
7179
7180 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7181 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7182 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7183 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7184 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7185 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7186 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7187 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7188
7189 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7190 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7191 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7192 @end deffn
7193
7194 @deffn Command {nand info} num
7195 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7196 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7197 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7198 status for each block.
7199 @end deffn
7200
7201 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7202 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7203 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7204
7205 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7206 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7207 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7208 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7209 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7210
7211 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7212 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7213 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7214 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7215 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7216 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7217 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7218 @end deffn
7219
7220 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7221 @subsection NAND Driver List
7222 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7223 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7224 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7225
7226 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
7227 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7228 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7229 address of the ECC controller.
7230 @example
7231 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7232 @end example
7233 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7234 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7235 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7236 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7237 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7238 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7239 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7240 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7241 @end deffn
7242 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7243 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7244 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7245 @end deffn
7246
7247 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7248 properly configured for input or output.
7249 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7250 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7251 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7252 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7253 @end deffn
7254 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7255 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7256 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7257 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7258 @end deffn
7259 @end deffn
7260
7261 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
7262 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7263 chips from Texas Instruments.
7264 It takes three extra parameters:
7265 address of the NAND chip;
7266 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7267 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7268 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7269 @example
7270 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7271 @end example
7272 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7273 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7274 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7275 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7276 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7277 @end deffn
7278
7279 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
7280 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7281 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7282 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7283 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7284 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7285 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7286 @end deffn
7287
7288 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7289 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7290 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7291 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7292 @end deffn
7293 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7294
7295 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
7296 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7297 should work for this chip as well.
7298 @end deffn
7299
7300 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
7301 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7302 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7303 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7304 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7305 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7306 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7307 @example
7308 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7309 @end example
7310 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7311 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7312 without parameter query status.
7313 @end deffn
7314 @end deffn
7315
7316 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
7317 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7318 parameter: the address of the controller.
7319 @example
7320 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7321 @end example
7322 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7323 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7324 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7325 change any behavior.
7326 @end deffn
7327
7328 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
7329 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
7330 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
7331 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
7332 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
7333 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7334 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7335 specialized commands.
7336 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7337 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7338 change any behavior.
7339 @end deffn
7340
7341 @section mFlash
7342
7343 @subsection mFlash Configuration
7344 @cindex mFlash Configuration
7345
7346 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
7347 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
7348 address @var{base}.
7349 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
7350 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
7351
7352 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
7353
7354 @example
7355 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
7356 @end example
7357
7358 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
7359
7360 @example
7361 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
7362 @end example
7363 @end deffn
7364
7365 @subsection mFlash commands
7366 @cindex mFlash commands
7367
7368 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
7369 Configure mflash PLL.
7370 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
7371 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
7372 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
7373 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
7374 @end deffn
7375
7376 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
7377 Configure bootable option.
7378 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
7379 (4kB) for boot.
7380 @end deffn
7381
7382 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
7383 Configure storage information.
7384 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
7385 written.
7386 @end deffn
7387
7388 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
7389 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
7390 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
7391 @end deffn
7392
7393 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
7394 Probe mflash.
7395 @end deffn
7396
7397 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
7398 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
7399 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
7400 @end deffn
7401
7402 @node Flash Programming
7403 @chapter Flash Programming
7404
7405 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7406 Programming can be achieved by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7407 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7408
7409 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7410 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7411
7412 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7413 @enumerate
7414 @item 'init' is executed.
7415 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7416 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7417 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7418 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7419 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7420 @end enumerate
7421
7422 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7423
7424 @example
7425 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7426 # are optional parameters
7427 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7428 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7429
7430 # binary files need the flash address passing
7431 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7432 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7433 @end example
7434
7435 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7436 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7437 @cindex PLD
7438 @cindex FPGA
7439
7440 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7441 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7442 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7443 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7444 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7445 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7446 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7447
7448 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7449
7450 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7451 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7452 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7453
7454 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7455 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7456
7457 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7458 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7459 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7460 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7461 behavior.
7462 @end deffn
7463
7464 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7465 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7466 @end deffn
7467
7468 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7469 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7470 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7471 @end deffn
7472
7473 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7474
7475 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7476 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7477 that particular type of PLD.
7478
7479 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
7480 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7481 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7482
7483 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7484 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7485 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7486
7487 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7488 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
7489 for FPGA @var{num}.
7490 @end deffn
7491 @end deffn
7492
7493 @node General Commands
7494 @chapter General Commands
7495 @cindex commands
7496
7497 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
7498 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
7499 commands are documented elsewhere.
7500
7501 Intent:
7502 @itemize @bullet
7503 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
7504 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
7505 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
7506 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
7507
7508 @item @b{From the human}
7509 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
7510 or via GDB (default port 3333).
7511
7512 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
7513 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
7514 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
7515
7516 @item @b{Machine Interface}
7517 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
7518 port is 5555.
7519 @end itemize
7520
7521
7522 @section Server Commands
7523
7524 @deffn {Command} exit
7525 Exits the current telnet session.
7526 @end deffn
7527
7528 @deffn {Command} help [string]
7529 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
7530 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
7531 Not every command provides helptext.
7532
7533 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
7534 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
7535 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
7536 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
7537 @end deffn
7538
7539 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
7540 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
7541 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
7542 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
7543 Useful in connection with script files
7544 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
7545 @end deffn
7546
7547 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
7548 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
7549 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
7550 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
7551
7552 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
7553 @example
7554 # redefine shutdown
7555 rename shutdown original_shutdown
7556 proc shutdown @{@} @{
7557 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
7558 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
7559 original_shutdown
7560 @}
7561 @end example
7562 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
7563 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
7564 @end deffn
7565
7566 @anchor{debuglevel}
7567 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
7568 @cindex message level
7569 Display debug level.
7570 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
7571 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
7572 Level 0 is error messages only;
7573 level 1 adds warnings;
7574 level 2 adds informational messages;
7575 level 3 adds debugging messages;
7576 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
7577 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
7578 the command line along with the location of that log
7579 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
7580 @xref{Running}.
7581 @end deffn
7582
7583 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
7584 Logs a message at "user" priority.
7585 Output @var{message} to stdout.
7586 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
7587 @example
7588 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
7589 @end example
7590 @end deffn
7591
7592 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
7593 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
7594 the initial log output channel is stderr.
7595 @end deffn
7596
7597 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
7598 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
7599 @end deffn
7600
7601 @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
7602 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
7603 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
7604 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
7605 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
7606 @end deffn
7607
7608 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
7609 @section Target State handling
7610 @cindex reset
7611 @cindex halt
7612 @cindex target initialization
7613
7614 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
7615 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
7616 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
7617 a current target which is used to perform the
7618 various operations. The current target may be changed
7619 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
7620 target which should become current.
7621
7622 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
7623 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
7624 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
7625 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
7626 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
7627
7628 @emph{With no arguments}:
7629 list all available registers for the current target,
7630 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
7631 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
7632 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
7633 are flagged as such.
7634
7635 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
7636 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
7637 bypassing any internal cache.
7638
7639 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
7640 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
7641 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
7642 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
7643 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
7644 relevant module will flush such values.
7645
7646 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
7647 Debug and trace infrastructure:
7648
7649 @example
7650 > reg
7651 ===== ARM registers
7652 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
7653 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
7654 (2) r2 (/32)
7655 ...
7656 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
7657 >
7658 @end example
7659 @end deffn
7660
7661 @deffn Command halt [ms]
7662 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
7663 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
7664 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
7665 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
7666 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
7667 (and enter debug mode).
7668 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
7669
7670 @quotation Warning
7671 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
7672 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
7673 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
7674 power mode by gating the core clock;
7675 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
7676
7677 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
7678 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
7679 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
7680 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
7681 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
7682 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
7683
7684 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
7685 work with a JTAG debugger.
7686 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
7687 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
7688 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
7689 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
7690 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
7691 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
7692 @end quotation
7693
7694 @end deffn
7695
7696 @deffn Command resume [address]
7697 Resume the target at its current code position,
7698 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7699 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
7700 @end deffn
7701
7702 @deffn Command step [address]
7703 Single-step the target at its current code position,
7704 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7705 @end deffn
7706
7707 @anchor{resetcommand}
7708 @deffn Command reset
7709 @deffnx Command {reset run}
7710 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
7711 @deffnx Command {reset init}
7712 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
7713 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
7714 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
7715
7716 The optional parameter specifies what should
7717 happen after the reset.
7718 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
7719 The other options will not work on all systems.
7720 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7721
7722 @itemize @minus
7723 @item @b{run} Let the target run
7724 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
7725 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
7726 @end itemize
7727 @end deffn
7728
7729 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
7730 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
7731 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
7732 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
7733 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
7734 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
7735 state.
7736 @end deffn
7737
7738 @section I/O Utilities
7739
7740 These commands are available when
7741 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
7742 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
7743 notably the ZY1000.
7744 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
7745
7746 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
7747
7748 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
7749 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
7750 the text file @file{filename}.
7751 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
7752 The last string is followed by a newline.
7753 @end deffn
7754
7755 @deffn Command cat filename
7756 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
7757 @end deffn
7758
7759 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
7760 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
7761 into @file{dest_filename}.
7762 @end deffn
7763
7764 @deffn Command ip
7765 @emph{No description provided.}
7766 @end deffn
7767
7768 @deffn Command ls
7769 @emph{No description provided.}
7770 @end deffn
7771
7772 @deffn Command mac
7773 @emph{No description provided.}
7774 @end deffn
7775
7776 @deffn Command meminfo
7777 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
7778 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
7779 @end deffn
7780
7781 @deffn Command peek
7782 @emph{No description provided.}
7783 @end deffn
7784
7785 @deffn Command poke
7786 @emph{No description provided.}
7787 @end deffn
7788
7789 @deffn Command rm filename
7790 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
7791 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
7792 @end deffn
7793
7794 @deffn Command trunc filename
7795 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
7796 @end deffn
7797
7798 @anchor{memoryaccess}
7799 @section Memory access commands
7800 @cindex memory access
7801
7802 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
7803 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
7804 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
7805 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
7806
7807 @enumerate
7808 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
7809 to change the current target.
7810 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
7811 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
7812 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
7813 @end enumerate
7814
7815 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
7816 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
7817 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
7818 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
7819 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
7820 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
7821 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
7822 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
7823 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
7824 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
7825 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
7826 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
7827 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
7828 @end deffn
7829
7830 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
7831 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
7832 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
7833 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
7834 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
7835 at the specified address @var{addr}.
7836 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
7837 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
7838 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
7839 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
7840 @end deffn
7841
7842 @anchor{imageaccess}
7843 @section Image loading commands
7844 @cindex image loading
7845 @cindex image dumping
7846
7847 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
7848 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
7849 binary file named @var{filename}.
7850 @end deffn
7851
7852 @deffn Command {fast_load}
7853 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
7854 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
7855 @end deffn
7856
7857 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
7858 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
7859 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
7860 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
7861 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
7862 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
7863 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
7864 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
7865 separately.
7866 @end deffn
7867
7868 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
7869 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
7870 The file format may optionally be specified
7871 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
7872 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
7873 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
7874 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
7875 @example
7876 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
7877 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
7878 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
7879 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
7880 $address $length
7881 @}
7882 @end example
7883 @end deffn
7884
7885 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
7886 Displays image section sizes and addresses
7887 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
7888 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
7889 The file format may optionally be specified
7890 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7891 @end deffn
7892
7893 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7894 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7895 The file format may optionally be specified
7896 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7897 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
7898 @end deffn
7899
7900 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7901 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7902 The file format may optionally be specified
7903 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7904 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
7905 @end deffn
7906
7907
7908 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
7909 @cindex breakpoint
7910 @cindex watchpoint
7911
7912 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
7913 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
7914 watchpoints.
7915 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
7916
7917 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
7918 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
7919 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
7920 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7921 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
7922 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
7923
7924 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
7925 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
7926 @end deffn
7927
7928 @deffn Command {rbp} address
7929 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
7930 @end deffn
7931
7932 @deffn Command {rwp} address
7933 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
7934 @end deffn
7935
7936 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
7937 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
7938 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7939 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
7940 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
7941 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
7942 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
7943 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
7944 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
7945 @end deffn
7946
7947 @section Misc Commands
7948
7949 @cindex profiling
7950 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
7951 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
7952 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
7953 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
7954 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
7955 limit the address range.
7956 @end deffn
7957
7958 @deffn Command {version}
7959 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
7960 @end deffn
7961
7962 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
7963 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
7964 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
7965 @end deffn
7966
7967 @node Architecture and Core Commands
7968 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
7969 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
7970 @cindex Core Specific Commands
7971
7972 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
7973 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
7974 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
7975 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
7976
7977 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
7978 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
7979 @cindex tracing
7980 @cindex ETM
7981 @cindex ETB
7982
7983 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
7984 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
7985 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
7986
7987 @itemize
7988 @item
7989 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
7990 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
7991 supports such an interface.
7992 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
7993 and trace port support.)
7994 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
7995 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
7996 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
7997 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
7998 in the board-specific configuration file.
7999 @item
8000 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8001 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8002 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8003 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8004 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8005 @end itemize
8006
8007 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8008
8009 @quotation Issues
8010 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8011 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8012
8013 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8014 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8015 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8016 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8017 dummy trace port driver}.
8018
8019 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8020 as well as tracing only during specific states
8021 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8022
8023 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8024 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8025 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8026 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8027 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8028
8029 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8030 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8031 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8032 this original style of JTAG access.
8033 @end quotation
8034
8035 @subsection ETM Configuration
8036 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8037
8038 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8039 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8040 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8041
8042 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8043 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8044 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8045 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8046 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8047 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8048 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8049 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8050 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8051
8052 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8053 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8054 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8055
8056 @quotation Warning
8057 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8058 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8059 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8060 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8061 @end quotation
8062
8063 @quotation Note
8064 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8065 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8066 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8067 what CPU activities are traced.
8068 @end quotation
8069 @end deffn
8070
8071 @deffn Command {etm info}
8072 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8073 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8074 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8075 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8076 @end deffn
8077
8078 @deffn Command {etm status}
8079 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8080 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8081 Did trace data overflow?
8082 Was it triggered?
8083 @end deffn
8084
8085 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8086 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8087 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8088 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8089 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8090
8091 @itemize
8092 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8093 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
8094 The value is one of
8095 @option{none} (save nothing),
8096 @option{data} (save data),
8097 @option{address} (save addresses),
8098 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8099 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8100 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8101 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8102 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8103 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8104 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8105 trace stream without an image of the code.
8106 @end itemize
8107 @end deffn
8108
8109 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8110 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8111 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8112 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8113 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8114
8115 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8116 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8117 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8118 @end deffn
8119
8120 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8121
8122 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8123 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8124 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8125
8126 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8127 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8128 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8129 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8130 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8131 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8132 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8133
8134 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8135
8136 @itemize
8137 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8138 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8139 for instruction access within that function's body.
8140 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8141 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8142 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8143 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8144 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8145 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8146 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8147 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8148 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8149 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8150 @item @emph{... more}
8151 @end itemize
8152
8153 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8154 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8155
8156 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
8157 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8158 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8159 @end deffn
8160
8161 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
8162 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8163 @end deffn
8164
8165 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8166 Opens an image file.
8167 @end deffn
8168
8169 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
8170 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8171 @end deffn
8172
8173 @deffn Command {etm start}
8174 Starts trace data collection.
8175 @end deffn
8176
8177 @deffn Command {etm stop}
8178 Stops trace data collection.
8179 @end deffn
8180
8181 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8182 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8183
8184 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8185
8186 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
8187 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8188 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8189 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8190 any trace data collection.}
8191 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8192 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8193 @end deffn
8194 @end deffn
8195
8196 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
8197 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8198 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8199 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8200 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8201 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8202 @end deffn
8203 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8204 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8205 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8206 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8207 trace trigger becomes active.
8208
8209 @itemize
8210 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8211 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8212 afterwards.
8213 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8214 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8215 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8216 what caused that event to happen.
8217 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8218 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8219 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8220 how the event caused trouble.
8221 @end itemize
8222 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8223 @end deffn
8224
8225 @end deffn
8226
8227 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
8228 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
8229 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
8230 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
8231 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
8232
8233 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8234 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
8235
8236 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
8237 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
8238 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
8239 @end deffn
8240
8241 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
8242 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
8243 @end deffn
8244
8245 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
8246 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
8247 @end deffn
8248 @end deffn
8249
8250 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8251 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8252 @cindex CTI
8253
8254 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8255 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8256 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8257 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8258 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8259 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8260
8261 @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-ctibase} base_address
8262 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8263 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8264 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8265 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8266 including additional configuration.
8267 @end deffn
8268
8269 @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8270 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8271 @end deffn
8272
8273 @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
8274 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8275 @end deffn
8276
8277 @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8278 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8279 @end deffn
8280
8281 @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8282 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8283 @end deffn
8284
8285 @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8286 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8287 of the CTI.
8288 @end deffn
8289
8290 @deffn Command {cti names}
8291 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8292 useful in TCL scripting.
8293 @end deffn
8294
8295 @section Generic ARM
8296 @cindex ARM
8297
8298 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8299 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8300 commands that may be available.
8301
8302 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8303 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8304 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8305 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8306 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8307 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8308 @end deffn
8309
8310 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8311 @cindex disassemble
8312 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8313 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8314 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8315 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8316 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8317 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8318 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8319
8320 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8321 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8322 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8323 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8324 with a handful of exceptions.
8325 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8326 @end deffn
8327
8328 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8329 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8330 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8331 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8332 and using the MCR instruction.
8333 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8334 an ARM register.)
8335 @end deffn
8336
8337 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8338 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8339 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8340 and the MRC instruction.
8341 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8342 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8343 an ARM register.)
8344 @end deffn
8345
8346 @deffn Command {arm reg}
8347 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8348 core mode if necessary.
8349 @end deffn
8350
8351 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8352 @cindex ARM semihosting
8353 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8354
8355 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8356 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8357 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8358 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8359 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8360 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8361 @end deffn
8362
8363 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8364 @cindex ARM semihosting
8365 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
8366
8367 @example
8368 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8369 @end example
8370
8371 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
8372 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
8373 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
8374 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
8375 @end deffn
8376
8377 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8378 @cindex ARM semihosting
8379 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8380 status.
8381
8382 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
8383 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
8384 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
8385 debugger.
8386 @end deffn
8387
8388 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8389 @cindex ARM semihosting
8390 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
8391
8392 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
8393 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
8394 the value returned by the target.
8395
8396 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
8397 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
8398 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
8399 encountering a break.
8400
8401 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
8402 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
8403 to the debugger.
8404 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
8405 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
8406 request or equivalent").
8407
8408 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
8409 this option (default: disabled).
8410 @end deffn
8411
8412 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
8413 @cindex ARMv4
8414 @cindex ARMv5
8415
8416 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
8417 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
8418 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
8419 variant.
8420
8421 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
8422 @cindex ARM7
8423 @cindex ARM9
8424
8425 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
8426 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
8427 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
8428 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
8429
8430 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8431 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
8432 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
8433 instead of breakpoints.
8434 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8435
8436 This should be
8437 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
8438 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
8439 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
8440 @end deffn
8441
8442 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8443 @cindex DCC
8444 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
8445 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
8446 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8447
8448 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
8449 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
8450 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
8451 @end deffn
8452
8453 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8454 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
8455 that don't check completion of the operation.
8456 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8457
8458 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
8459 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
8460 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
8461 @end deffn
8462
8463 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
8464 @cindex ARM720T
8465
8466 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
8467 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8468 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
8469 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
8470
8471 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
8472 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8473 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8474
8475 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
8476 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8477 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
8478 @end deffn
8479
8480 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
8481 @cindex ARM9
8482
8483 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
8484 integer processors.
8485 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
8486
8487 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
8488 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
8489 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
8490 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
8491
8492 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
8493 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8494 @cindex vector_catch
8495 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
8496 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
8497 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
8498 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
8499 to those hardware vectors.
8500
8501 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
8502 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
8503 vector catch hardware to intercept
8504 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
8505 @option{none} of them,
8506 or a list with one or more of the following:
8507 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
8508 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
8509 @end deffn
8510
8511 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
8512 @cindex ARM920T
8513
8514 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
8515 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8516 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
8517 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8518 and ARM9 commands.
8519
8520 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
8521 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
8522 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
8523 @end deffn
8524
8525 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
8526 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8527 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8528 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
8529 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
8530 (Not all registers can be written.)
8531 @end deffn
8532
8533 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
8534 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8535 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8536
8537 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
8538 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
8539 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
8540 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
8541 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
8542 or using zero if no other address is provided.
8543 @end deffn
8544
8545 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
8546 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
8547 @end deffn
8548
8549 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
8550 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
8551 @end deffn
8552
8553 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
8554 @cindex ARM926ej-s
8555
8556 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
8557 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
8558 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
8559 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8560 and ARM9 commands.
8561
8562 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
8563 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
8564
8565 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
8566 Print information about the caches found.
8567 @end deffn
8568
8569 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
8570 @cindex ARM966E
8571
8572 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
8573 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8574 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8575 and ARM9 commands.
8576
8577 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
8578 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8579 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8580 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
8581 ARM966E-S TRM.
8582 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
8583 as required for BIST support.
8584 @end deffn
8585
8586 @subsection XScale specific commands
8587 @cindex XScale
8588
8589 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
8590
8591 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
8592 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
8593 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
8594 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
8595 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
8596 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
8597 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
8598
8599 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
8600 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
8601 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
8602 the mini-IC.
8603
8604 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
8605 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
8606 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
8607 code layout in memory:
8608 @example
8609 _vectors:
8610 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8611 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8612 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8613 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8614 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8615 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8616 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8617 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8618 .org 0x100
8619 .long real_reset_vector
8620 .long real_ui_handler
8621 .long real_swi_handler
8622 .long real_pf_abort
8623 .long real_data_abort
8624 .long 0 /* unused */
8625 .long real_irq_handler
8626 .long real_fiq_handler
8627 @end example
8628
8629 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
8630 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
8631 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
8632 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
8633 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
8634 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
8635 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
8636 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
8637 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
8638 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
8639 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
8640 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
8641 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
8642 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
8643 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
8644 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
8645 software.
8646
8647 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
8648 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
8649 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
8650 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
8651
8652 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
8653 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
8654 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
8655 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
8656 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
8657 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
8658 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
8659 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
8660 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
8661
8662 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
8663 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8664
8665 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
8666 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
8667 @end deffn
8668
8669 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
8670 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
8671 @end deffn
8672
8673 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
8674 Displays information about the CPU caches.
8675 @end deffn
8676
8677 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
8678 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8679 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8680 @end deffn
8681
8682 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
8683 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
8684 @end deffn
8685
8686 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8687 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
8688 @end deffn
8689
8690 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
8691 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
8692 @end deffn
8693
8694 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8695 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
8696 @end deffn
8697
8698 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8699 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
8700 @end deffn
8701
8702 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
8703 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
8704 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
8705 and modifying how it is emptied.
8706 @end deffn
8707
8708 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
8709 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
8710 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
8711 The image @var{type} may be one of
8712 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
8713 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
8714 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
8715 @end deffn
8716
8717 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
8718 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
8719 @cindex vector_catch
8720 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
8721 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
8722
8723 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
8724 @example
8725 0x01 Trap Reset
8726 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
8727 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
8728 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
8729 0x10 Trap Data Abort
8730 0x20 reserved
8731 0x40 Trap IRQ
8732 0x80 Trap FIQ
8733 @end example
8734 @end deffn
8735
8736 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
8737 @cindex vector_table
8738
8739 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
8740 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
8741 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
8742 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
8743 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
8744
8745 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
8746
8747 @end deffn
8748
8749 @section ARMv6 Architecture
8750 @cindex ARMv6
8751
8752 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
8753 @cindex ARM11
8754
8755 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8756 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
8757 which is enabled by default.
8758 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8759 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
8760 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
8761 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
8762 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
8763 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
8764 @end deffn
8765
8766 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8767 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
8768 which is enabled by default.
8769 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8770 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
8771 @end deffn
8772
8773 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8774 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
8775 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
8776 they are disabled by default.
8777 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
8778 @end deffn
8779
8780 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
8781 @cindex vector_catch
8782 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
8783 coprocessor 14 register 7.
8784 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
8785
8786 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8787 for certain hardware events.
8788 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
8789 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
8790 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
8791 @end deffn
8792
8793 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
8794 @cindex ARMv7
8795 @cindex ARMv8
8796
8797 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
8798 @cindex Cortex-A
8799
8800 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
8801 display information about target caches
8802 @end deffn
8803
8804 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
8805 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
8806 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
8807 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
8808 Defaults to 'off'.
8809 @end deffn
8810
8811 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
8812 Initialize core debug
8813 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
8814 @end deffn
8815
8816 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_off}
8817 Disable SMP mode
8818 @end deffn
8819
8820 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_on}
8821 Enable SMP mode
8822 @end deffn
8823
8824 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
8825 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
8826 @end deffn
8827
8828 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8829 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
8830 @end deffn
8831
8832 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
8833 configure l2x cache
8834 @end deffn
8835
8836 @deffn Command {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
8837 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
8838 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
8839 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
8840 possible (4096) entries are printed.
8841 @end deffn
8842
8843 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
8844 @cindex Cortex-R
8845
8846 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
8847 Initialize core debug
8848 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
8849 @end deffn
8850
8851 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8852 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
8853 @end deffn
8854
8855
8856 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
8857 @cindex tracing
8858 @cindex SWO
8859 @cindex SWV
8860 @cindex TPIU
8861 @cindex ITM
8862 @cindex ETM
8863
8864 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
8865 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
8866 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
8867
8868 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
8869 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
8870 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
8871 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
8872
8873 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
8874 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
8875 debugger adapter features.
8876
8877 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
8878 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
8879
8880 Command options:
8881 @itemize @minus
8882 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
8883 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
8884 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
8885 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
8886 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
8887 either a regular file or a named pipe);
8888 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
8889 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
8890 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
8891 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
8892 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
8893 coding;
8894 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
8895 regular UART 8N1) coding;
8896 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
8897 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
8898 data is to be output via SWO;
8899 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
8900 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
8901 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
8902 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
8903 rate automatically.
8904 @end itemize
8905
8906 Example usage:
8907 @enumerate
8908 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
8909 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
8910 enough to:
8911 @example
8912 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
8913 ...
8914 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
8915 ...
8916 @end example
8917 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
8918 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
8919 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
8920 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
8921 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
8922 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
8923 @example
8924 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
8925 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
8926 @end example
8927 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
8928 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
8929 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
8930 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
8931 @example
8932 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
8933 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
8934 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
8935 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
8936 @end example
8937 @end enumerate
8938 @end deffn
8939
8940 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8941 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
8942 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
8943 @end deffn
8944
8945 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8946 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
8947 @end deffn
8948
8949 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
8950 @cindex Cortex-M
8951
8952 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8953 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
8954
8955 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
8956 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
8957 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
8958 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
8959 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
8960 the step command leaves with the core running.
8961
8962 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
8963 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
8964 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
8965 does.
8966
8967 Default is @option{auto}.
8968 @end deffn
8969
8970 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8971 @cindex vector_catch
8972 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8973 for certain hardware events.
8974
8975 Parameters request interception of
8976 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
8977 @option{none} of them,
8978 or one or more of the following:
8979 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
8980 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
8981 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
8982 @option{irq_err},
8983 @option{state_err},
8984 @option{chk_err}, or
8985 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
8986 @option{reset}.
8987 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
8988 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
8989 are mapped to HardFault.
8990 UsageFault checks for
8991 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
8992 must also be explicitly enabled.
8993
8994 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
8995 @end deffn
8996
8997 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{srst}|@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
8998 Control reset handling. The default @option{srst} is to use srst if fitted,
8999 otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
9000 @itemize @minus
9001 @item @option{srst} use hardware srst if fitted otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
9002 @item @option{sysresetreq} use NVIC SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9003 @item @option{vectreset} use NVIC VECTRESET to reset system.
9004 @end itemize
9005 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for all current Cortex-M cores.
9006 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9007 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler to manually reset
9008 the peripherals.
9009 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9010 @end deffn
9011
9012 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9013 @cindex ARMv8-A
9014 @cindex aarch64
9015
9016 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
9017 Display information about target caches
9018 @end deffn
9019
9020 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
9021 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9022 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9023 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9024 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9025 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9026 @end deffn
9027
9028 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp_on|smp_off}
9029 Enable and disable SMP handling. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9030 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9031 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9032 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9033 @end deffn
9034
9035 @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9036 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9037 @option{on}.
9038 @end deffn
9039
9040 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9041
9042 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9043 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9044
9045 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9046
9047 @deffn Command {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9048 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9049 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9050 @end deffn
9051
9052 @deffn Command {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9053 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9054 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9055 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9056 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9057 @end deffn
9058
9059 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9060
9061 @deffn Command {esirisc flush_caches}
9062 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9063 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9064 @end deffn
9065
9066 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9067
9068 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9069 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9070 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9071 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9072 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9073 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9074 can be collected.
9075
9076 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9077 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9078 tooling.
9079
9080 @quotation Issues
9081 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9082 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9083 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9084 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9085
9086 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9087 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9088 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9089 software operation on the CPU.
9090 @end quotation
9091
9092 @deffn Command {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9093 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9094 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9095 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9096 @end deffn
9097
9098 @deffn Command {esirisc trace fifo} address
9099 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9100 @end deffn
9101
9102 @deffn Command {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9103 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9104 control is disabled.
9105 @end deffn
9106
9107 @deffn Command {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9108 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9109 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9110 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9111
9112 Supported trace formats:
9113 @itemize
9114 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9115 timing to be determined.
9116 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9117 addresses.
9118 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9119 @end itemize
9120 @end deffn
9121
9122 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9123 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9124 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9125 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9126
9127 Supported conditions:
9128 @itemize
9129 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9130 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9131 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9132 instruction matches start data and mask.
9133 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9134 instruction matches start data and mask.
9135 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9136 data and mask.
9137 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9138 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9139 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9140 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9141 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9142 @end itemize
9143 @end deffn
9144
9145 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9146 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9147 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9148 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9149
9150 Supported conditions:
9151 @itemize
9152 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9153 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9154 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9155 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9156 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9157 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9158 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9159 data and mask.
9160 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9161 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9162 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9163 @end itemize
9164 @end deffn
9165
9166 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9167 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9168
9169 Supported triggers:
9170 @itemize
9171 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9172 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9173 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9174 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9175 collection.
9176 @end itemize
9177 @end deffn
9178
9179 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9180
9181 @deffn Command {esirisc trace init}
9182 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9183 configuration changes. If an trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9184 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9185 @end deffn
9186
9187 @deffn Command {esirisc trace info}
9188 Display trace configuration.
9189 @end deffn
9190
9191 @deffn Command {esirisc trace status}
9192 Display trace collection status.
9193 @end deffn
9194
9195 @deffn Command {esirisc trace start}
9196 Start manual trace collection.
9197 @end deffn
9198
9199 @deffn Command {esirisc trace stop}
9200 Stop manual trace collection.
9201 @end deffn
9202
9203 @deffn Command {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
9204 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
9205 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
9206 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9207 @option{size} options using DMA.
9208 @end deffn
9209
9210 @deffn Command {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
9211 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
9212 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
9213 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9214 @option{size} options using DMA.
9215 @end deffn
9216
9217 @section Intel Architecture
9218
9219 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
9220 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
9221 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
9222 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
9223 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
9224 @itemize
9225 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
9226 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
9227 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
9228 @end itemize
9229
9230 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
9231 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
9232 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
9233
9234 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
9235 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9236 @end deffn
9237
9238 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
9239 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9240 @end deffn
9241
9242 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
9243 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9244 @end deffn
9245
9246 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
9247 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9248 @end deffn
9249
9250 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
9251 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9252 @end deffn
9253
9254 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
9255 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9256 @end deffn
9257
9258 @section OpenRISC Architecture
9259
9260 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
9261 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
9262
9263 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
9264 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
9265 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
9266 @end deffn
9267 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
9268 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
9269
9270 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
9271
9272 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
9273 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
9274 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
9275 @end deffn
9276
9277 @subsection Registers commands
9278 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
9279 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
9280 included in the generated target descriptor file.
9281
9282 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
9283
9284 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
9285 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
9286 and "timer" groups.
9287
9288 @emph{example:}
9289 @example
9290 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
9291 @end example
9292
9293
9294 @end deffn
9295 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
9296 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
9297
9298 @emph{group} can be "system",
9299 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
9300 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
9301 @end deffn
9302
9303 @section RISC-V Architecture
9304
9305 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
9306 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
9307 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
9308 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
9309 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
9310 implement version 0.11.
9311
9312 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
9313
9314 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
9315 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
9316 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
9317
9318 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
9319
9320 @deffn Command {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9321 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
9322 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
9323
9324 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
9325 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
9326 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
9327 CSRs.
9328 @end deffn
9329
9330 @deffn Command {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9331 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
9332 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
9333 @end deffn
9334
9335 @deffn Command {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9336 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
9337 deasserted.
9338 @end deffn
9339
9340 @deffn Command {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
9341 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
9342 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
9343 @end deffn
9344
9345 @deffn Command {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
9346 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off, prefer to
9347 use the Program Buffer to access memory.
9348 @end deffn
9349
9350 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
9351
9352 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
9353 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
9354 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
9355 @example
9356 set challenge [ocd_riscv authdata_read]
9357 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
9358 @end example
9359
9360 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_read}
9361 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata. Note that to get read value back in
9362 a TCL script, it needs to be invoked as @command{ocd_riscv authdata_read}.
9363 @end deffn
9364
9365 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_write} value
9366 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
9367 @end deffn
9368
9369 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
9370
9371 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
9372 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
9373
9374 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_read}
9375 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value. Note that to get
9376 read value back in a TCL script, it needs to be invoked as @command{ocd_riscv
9377 dmi_read}.
9378 @end deffn
9379
9380 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_write} address value
9381 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
9382 @end deffn
9383
9384 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
9385 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
9386 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
9387 @cindex tracing
9388 @cindex libdcc
9389 @cindex DCC
9390 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
9391 the target uses appropriate libraries.
9392 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
9393 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
9394
9395 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
9396 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
9397 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
9398 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
9399 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
9400 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
9401
9402 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
9403 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
9404 arrays of various size integers from the target,
9405 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
9406 The target being debugged may
9407 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
9408 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
9409 each supported by a command:
9410
9411 @itemize
9412 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
9413 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
9414 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
9415 finding out how some fault was triggered.
9416
9417 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
9418 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
9419 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
9420
9421 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
9422 and then displayed at any time.
9423 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
9424
9425 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
9426 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
9427 @end itemize
9428
9429 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
9430 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
9431 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
9432 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
9433 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
9434 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
9435 does the same thing.
9436
9437 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
9438 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
9439 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
9440 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
9441 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
9442
9443 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
9444 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
9445 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
9446 @end deffn
9447
9448 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
9449 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
9450 in the order they triggered.
9451 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
9452 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
9453 history records.
9454 @end deffn
9455
9456 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
9457 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
9458 they have been triggered.
9459 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
9460 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
9461 and associates it with that identifier.
9462
9463 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
9464 are not related except by this command.
9465 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
9466 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
9467 @end deffn
9468
9469
9470 @node JTAG Commands
9471 @chapter JTAG Commands
9472 @cindex JTAG Commands
9473 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
9474 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
9475 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
9476 may be needed to work with targets which require special
9477 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
9478
9479 To use these commands you will need to understand some
9480 of the basics of JTAG, including:
9481
9482 @itemize @bullet
9483 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
9484 devices such as a CPUs.
9485 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
9486 standard state machine (in parallel)
9487 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
9488 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
9489 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
9490 while the reading previous ones.
9491 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
9492 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
9493 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
9494 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
9495 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
9496 registers.
9497 @end itemize
9498
9499 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
9500
9501 These commands are used by developers who need to access
9502 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
9503 the order of TAP state transitions.
9504 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
9505 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
9506 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
9507 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
9508 these commands are not available.
9509
9510 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9511 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
9512 that specify the entire register.
9513 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
9514 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
9515 The return value holds the original value of each
9516 of those fields.
9517
9518 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
9519 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
9520 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
9521 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
9522 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
9523
9524 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
9525 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
9526
9527 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
9528 in that state.
9529 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
9530 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
9531 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
9532
9533 @quotation Warning
9534 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
9535 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
9536 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
9537 data registers, which may have different lengths.
9538 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
9539 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
9540 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
9541 (by connecting a different scan chain).
9542 @end quotation
9543 @end deffn
9544
9545 @deffn Command {flush_count}
9546 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
9547 This may be used for performance tuning.
9548
9549 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
9550 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
9551 not change with the amount of data which is written.
9552 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
9553 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
9554 instead of batching them into larger operations.
9555 @end deffn
9556
9557 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9558 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
9559 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
9560 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
9561 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
9562 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
9563
9564 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
9565 in that state.
9566 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
9567 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
9568 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
9569
9570 @quotation Note
9571 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
9572 register values, unlike data register values.
9573 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
9574 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
9575 @end quotation
9576 @end deffn
9577
9578 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
9579 Set values of reset signals.
9580 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
9581 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
9582 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
9583 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
9584 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
9585 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
9586 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
9587
9588 Note that TRST is specially handled.
9589 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
9590 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
9591 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
9592 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
9593 instead of the TRST signal.
9594 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
9595 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
9596 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
9597 with handlers for that event.
9598 @end deffn
9599
9600 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
9601 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
9602 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
9603 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
9604 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
9605 Then, in a series of single state transitions
9606 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
9607 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
9608 The final state must also be stable.
9609 @end deffn
9610
9611 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
9612 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
9613 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
9614 Instructions often need some time
9615 to execute before they take effect.
9616 @end deffn
9617
9618 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
9619 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
9620
9621 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9622 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
9623 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
9624 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
9625 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
9626 @end deffn
9627
9628 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9629 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
9630 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
9631 must also be enabled.
9632 Default is enabled.
9633 @end deffn
9634
9635 @section TAP state names
9636 @cindex TAP state names
9637
9638 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
9639 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
9640 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
9641 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
9642
9643 @itemize @bullet
9644 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
9645 acts as if TRST were pulsed
9646 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
9647 @item @b{DRSELECT}
9648 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
9649 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9650 through the data register
9651 @item @b{DREXIT1}
9652 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
9653 for update or more shifting
9654 @item @b{DREXIT2}
9655 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
9656 @item @b{IRSELECT}
9657 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
9658 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9659 through the instruction register
9660 @item @b{IREXIT1}
9661 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
9662 for update or more shifting
9663 @item @b{IREXIT2}
9664 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
9665 @end itemize
9666
9667 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
9668 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
9669 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
9670 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
9671
9672 @itemize @bullet
9673 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
9674 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
9675 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
9676 may not be as expected.
9677 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
9678 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
9679 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
9680 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
9681 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
9682 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
9683 @end itemize
9684
9685 @node Boundary Scan Commands
9686 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
9687
9688 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
9689 boundary scan based hardware testing.
9690 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
9691 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
9692
9693 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
9694 @cindex Serial Vector Format
9695 @cindex SVF
9696
9697 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
9698 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
9699 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9700 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9701
9702 @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
9703 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
9704 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9705 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
9706
9707 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
9708 affect their semantics.
9709
9710 Command options:
9711 @itemize @minus
9712 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
9713 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
9714 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
9715 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
9716 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
9717 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
9718 on the real interface;
9719 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
9720 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
9721 errors.
9722 @end itemize
9723 @end deffn
9724
9725 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9726 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9727 @cindex XSVF
9728
9729 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
9730 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
9731 Xilinx devices.
9732 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9733 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9734
9735 @quotation Important
9736 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
9737 @end quotation
9738
9739 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
9740 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9741 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
9742 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
9743 that TAP.
9744 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
9745 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
9746 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
9747 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
9748 @end deffn
9749
9750 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
9751 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
9752 after building the software.
9753 You may find them useful:
9754
9755 @itemize
9756 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
9757 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
9758 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
9759 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
9760 @end itemize
9761
9762 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
9763 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
9764 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
9765 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
9766 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
9767 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
9768 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
9769
9770
9771 @node Utility Commands
9772 @chapter Utility Commands
9773 @cindex Utility Commands
9774
9775 @section RAM testing
9776 @cindex RAM testing
9777
9778 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
9779 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
9780 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
9781 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
9782 hardware problems.
9783
9784 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
9785 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
9786 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
9787 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
9788
9789 Load the memory testing functions with
9790
9791 @example
9792 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
9793 @end example
9794
9795 to get access to the following facilities:
9796
9797 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
9798 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
9799 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
9800 @end deffn
9801
9802 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
9803 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
9804 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
9805 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
9806 @end deffn
9807
9808 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
9809 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
9810 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
9811 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
9812 @end deffn
9813
9814 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
9815 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
9816 @end deffn
9817
9818 @section Firmware recovery helpers
9819 @cindex Firmware recovery
9820
9821 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
9822 devices recovery with JTAG.
9823
9824 For quickstart instructions run:
9825 @example
9826 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
9827 @end example
9828
9829 @node TFTP
9830 @chapter TFTP
9831 @cindex TFTP
9832 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
9833 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
9834
9835 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
9836 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
9837 server (tftpd). For example,
9838
9839 @example
9840 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
9841 @end example
9842
9843 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
9844 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
9845
9846 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
9847 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
9848 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
9849 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
9850
9851 @node GDB and OpenOCD
9852 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
9853 @cindex GDB
9854 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
9855 to debug remote targets.
9856 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
9857
9858 @itemize
9859 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
9860 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
9861 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
9862 as shown in this chapter.
9863 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
9864 that also will probably need to be configured.
9865 @end itemize
9866
9867 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
9868 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
9869 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
9870 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
9871 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
9872 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
9873
9874 @section Connecting to GDB
9875 @cindex Connecting to GDB
9876 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
9877 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
9878 errors, which has since been fixed; see
9879 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
9880
9881 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
9882
9883 @enumerate
9884 @item
9885 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
9886 @example
9887 target remote localhost:3333
9888 @end example
9889 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
9890
9891 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
9892 @example
9893 target extended-remote localhost:3333
9894 @end example
9895 @item
9896 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
9897 @example
9898 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
9899 @end example
9900 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
9901 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
9902 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
9903 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
9904 @end enumerate
9905
9906 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
9907 GDB command line.
9908
9909 @section Sample GDB session startup
9910
9911 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
9912 than they do when you're debugging locally.
9913 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
9914 small ARM program.
9915 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
9916 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
9917
9918 @example
9919 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
9920 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
9921 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
9922 ...
9923 (gdb) monitor reset halt
9924 ...
9925 (gdb) load
9926 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
9927 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
9928 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
9929 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
9930 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
9931 (gdb) continue
9932 Continuing.
9933 ...
9934 @end example
9935
9936 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
9937 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
9938 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
9939 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
9940
9941 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
9942
9943 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
9944 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
9945 packet size and the device's memory map.
9946 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
9947 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
9948 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
9949
9950 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
9951 You may need to set those up by hand.
9952 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
9953 something like:
9954
9955 @example
9956 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
9957 @end example
9958
9959 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
9960
9961 @example
9962 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
9963 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
9964 @end example
9965
9966 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
9967 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
9968 do not have such restrictions.
9969
9970 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
9971 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
9972 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
9973 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
9974
9975 @section Programming using GDB
9976 @cindex Programming using GDB
9977 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
9978
9979 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
9980 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
9981 @example
9982 gdb_memory_map disable
9983 @end example
9984 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
9985 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
9986 working area.
9987
9988 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
9989 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
9990 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
9991 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
9992
9993 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
9994 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
9995
9996 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
9997 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
9998 @example
9999 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
10000 @end example
10001
10002 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
10003 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
10004
10005 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
10006 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
10007 will be used.
10008
10009 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
10010 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
10011 @example
10012 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
10013 @end example
10014 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
10015
10016 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
10017 can be used.
10018
10019 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10020 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10021 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
10022
10023 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
10024 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
10025 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
10026
10027 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
10028 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
10029 and GDB treats it as it were running.
10030 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
10031 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
10032 without any intrusion of the target process.
10033
10034 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10035 Place following command after target configuration:
10036 @example
10037 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
10038 @end example
10039
10040 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
10041 switch off gdb_memory_map:
10042 @example
10043 gdb_memory_map disable
10044 @end example
10045
10046 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
10047 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
10048 @example
10049 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
10050 @end example
10051
10052 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
10053 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
10054
10055 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target remote ...} and inspect memory
10056 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
10057 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
10058 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
10059
10060 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
10061 previously shown varibles.
10062
10063 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
10064 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
10065 @cindex SMP
10066 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
10067 @itemize @bullet
10068 @item j - smp status request
10069 @item J - smp set request
10070 @end itemize
10071
10072 OpenOCD implements :
10073 @itemize @bullet
10074 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
10075 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
10076 @option{E01} for target not smp.
10077 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
10078 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
10079 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
10080 @end itemize
10081
10082 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
10083 @itemize @bullet
10084 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
10085 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
10086 @example
10087 set $_core 1
10088 #Jc01 packet is sent
10089 print $_core
10090 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
10091 @end example
10092
10093 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
10094 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
10095
10096 @example
10097 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
10098 define toggle0
10099 maint packet Jc0
10100 continue
10101 main packet Jc-1
10102 end
10103 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
10104 define toggle1
10105 maint packet Jc1
10106 continue
10107 main packet Jc-1
10108 end
10109 @end example
10110 @end itemize
10111
10112 @section RTOS Support
10113 @cindex RTOS Support
10114 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
10115
10116 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
10117 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
10118
10119 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
10120 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
10121 GDB commands.
10122
10123 @* An example setup is below:
10124
10125 @example
10126 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
10127 @end example
10128
10129 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
10130
10131 Currently supported rtos's include:
10132 @itemize @bullet
10133 @item @option{eCos}
10134 @item @option{ThreadX}
10135 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
10136 @item @option{linux}
10137 @item @option{ChibiOS}
10138 @item @option{embKernel}
10139 @item @option{mqx}
10140 @item @option{uCOS-III}
10141 @item @option{nuttx}
10142 @end itemize
10143
10144 @quotation Note
10145 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
10146 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
10147 @end quotation
10148
10149 @table @code
10150 @item eCos symbols
10151 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
10152 @item ThreadX symbols
10153 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
10154 @item FreeRTOS symbols
10155 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
10156 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
10157 @tex
10158 \begingroup
10159 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
10160 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
10161 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
10162 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
10163 \par
10164 \endgroup
10165 @end tex
10166 @item linux symbols
10167 init_task.
10168 @item ChibiOS symbols
10169 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
10170 @item embKernel symbols
10171 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
10172 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
10173 @item mqx symbols
10174 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
10175 @item uC/OS-III symbols
10176 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
10177 @item nuttx symbols
10178 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable
10179 @end table
10180
10181 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
10182 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
10183
10184 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
10185 along with the project:
10186
10187 @table @code
10188 @item FreeRTOS
10189 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
10190 @item uC/OS-III
10191 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
10192 @end table
10193
10194 @node Tcl Scripting API
10195 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
10196 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
10197 @cindex Tcl scripts
10198 @section API rules
10199
10200 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
10201 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
10202 of state information as an argument to each proc.
10203
10204 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
10205 pair list and lists.
10206
10207 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
10208 list.
10209
10210 @example
10211 > set foo(me) Duane
10212 > set foo(you) Oyvind
10213 > set foo(mouse) Micky
10214 > set foo(duck) Donald
10215 @end example
10216
10217 If one does this:
10218
10219 @example
10220 > set foo
10221 @end example
10222
10223 The result is:
10224
10225 @example
10226 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
10227 @end example
10228
10229 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
10230
10231 @verbatim
10232 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
10233 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
10234 }
10235 @end verbatim
10236
10237 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
10238 should be passed in to the proc in question.
10239
10240 @section Internal low-level Commands
10241
10242 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
10243 invoke directly.
10244
10245 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
10246 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
10247 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
10248
10249 @itemize @bullet
10250 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10251
10252 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
10253 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10254
10255 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
10256 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
10257
10258 Return information about the flash banks
10259
10260 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
10261
10262 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
10263 its execution. Example:
10264
10265 @example
10266 > capture "reset init"
10267 @end example
10268
10269 @end itemize
10270
10271 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
10272 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
10273 called "flash_banks".
10274
10275 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
10276
10277 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
10278 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
10279 holds one of the following values:
10280
10281 @itemize @bullet
10282 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
10283 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating system.
10284 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
10285 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
10286 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
10287 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating system
10288 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
10289 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
10290 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
10291 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
10292 @end itemize
10293
10294 Note: 'winxx' was chosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
10295
10296 @quotation Note
10297 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
10298 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
10299 @code{jim_platform} (because it
10300 is jim, not real tcl).
10301 @end quotation
10302
10303 @section Tcl RPC server
10304 @cindex RPC
10305
10306 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
10307 commands and receive the results.
10308
10309 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
10310 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
10311 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
10312 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
10313 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
10314
10315 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
10316 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
10317 @command{capture} command.
10318
10319 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
10320
10321 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
10322 @cindex RPC Notifications
10323
10324 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10325 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10326
10327 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
10328 in the following format.
10329
10330 @verbatim
10331 type target_event event [event-name]
10332 type target_state state [state-name]
10333 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
10334 @end verbatim
10335
10336 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
10337 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
10338 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10339 Defaults to off.
10340
10341 @end deffn
10342
10343 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
10344 @cindex RPC trace output
10345
10346 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10347 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10348
10349 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
10350
10351 @verbatim
10352 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
10353 @end verbatim
10354
10355 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
10356 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
10357 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10358 Defaults to off.
10359
10360 See an example application here:
10361 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
10362
10363 @end deffn
10364
10365 @node FAQ
10366 @chapter FAQ
10367 @cindex faq
10368 @enumerate
10369 @anchor{faqrtck}
10370 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
10371 @cindex RTCK
10372 @cindex adaptive clocking
10373 @*
10374
10375 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
10376 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
10377 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
10378 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
10379
10380 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
10381 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
10382 for example. There are 2 basic options:
10383 @enumerate
10384 @item
10385 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
10386 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
10387 @item
10388 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
10389 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
10390 @end enumerate
10391
10392 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
10393 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
10394 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
10395 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
10396 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
10397 power).
10398
10399 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
10400 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
10401 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
10402 ARM926 scenario).
10403 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
10404 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
10405 JTAG can use a faster clock.
10406
10407 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
10408 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
10409 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
10410 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
10411
10412 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
10413
10414 In order to make use of this,
10415 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
10416 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
10417
10418 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
10419 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
10420 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
10421 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
10422 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
10423
10424 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
10425 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
10426 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
10427 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
10428
10429 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
10430 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
10431 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
10432 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
10433 with a CPLD.
10434 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
10435 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
10436 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
10437 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
10438 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
10439 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
10440
10441 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
10442
10443 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
10444
10445 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
10446 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
10447 depending on the chips on your board.
10448 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
10449 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
10450 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
10451
10452 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
10453 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
10454 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
10455
10456 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
10457 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
10458 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
10459 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
10460
10461 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
10462 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
10463 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
10464 this way.
10465
10466 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
10467 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
10468 clock rate.
10469 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
10470 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
10471 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
10472
10473 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
10474
10475 @example
10476 # Example: 1.234MHz
10477 adapter_khz 1234
10478 @end example
10479
10480
10481 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
10482
10483 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
10484 around Windows filenames.
10485
10486 @example
10487 > echo \a
10488
10489 > echo @{\a@}
10490 \a
10491 > echo "\a"
10492
10493 >
10494 @end example
10495
10496
10497 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
10498
10499 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
10500 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
10501 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
10502
10503 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
10504 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
10505 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
10506
10507 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
10508 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
10509 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
10510
10511 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
10512
10513 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
10514 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
10515 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
10516 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
10517
10518 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
10519 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
10520 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
10521
10522 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
10523 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
10524
10525 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
10526 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
10527 memory read caused data abort".
10528
10529 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
10530 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
10531 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
10532 be done, feel free to add this here.
10533
10534 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
10535 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
10536 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
10537 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
10538 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
10539 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
10540 gracefully stops.
10541
10542 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
10543 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
10544 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
10545
10546 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
10547 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
10548 bytes. Painful...
10549
10550
10551 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
10552 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
10553
10554 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
10555 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
10556 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
10557 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
10558 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
10559 reset, everything else should work fine.
10560
10561 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
10562 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
10563 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
10564 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
10565
10566 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
10567 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
10568 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
10569 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
10570
10571 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
10572
10573 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
10574 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
10575 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
10576
10577 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
10578 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
10579
10580 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
10581 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
10582 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
10583 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
10584 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
10585 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
10586 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
10587 clock frequency?
10588
10589 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
10590 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
10591 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
10592 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
10593 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
10594
10595 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
10596
10597 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
10598 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
10599 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
10600 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
10601 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
10602 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
10603 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
10604
10605 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
10606
10607 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
10608 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
10609 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
10610 up DRAM and loading it with code.
10611
10612 @anchor{faqtaporder}
10613 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
10614 particular order?
10615
10616 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
10617 the same order used by the hardware.
10618
10619 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
10620 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
10621 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
10622 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
10623 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
10624 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
10625
10626 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
10627 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
10628 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
10629 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
10630
10631 @itemize @bullet
10632 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
10633 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
10634 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
10635 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
10636 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
10637 @end itemize
10638
10639 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
10640
10641 @itemize @bullet
10642 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
10643 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
10644 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
10645 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
10646 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
10647 @end itemize
10648
10649
10650 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
10651 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
10652 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
10653
10654 TODO.
10655
10656 @end enumerate
10657
10658 @node Tcl Crash Course
10659 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
10660 @cindex Tcl
10661
10662 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
10663 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
10664 how the Tcl scripts work.
10665
10666 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
10667 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
10668 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
10669 OpenOCD.
10670
10671 @section Tcl Rule #1
10672 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
10673 @enumerate
10674 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
10675 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10676 @end enumerate
10677
10678 The Tcl equal is this:
10679
10680 @enumerate
10681 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
10682 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10683 @end enumerate
10684
10685 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
10686 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
10687
10688 @section Tcl Rule #1b
10689 There is a second pair of rules.
10690 @enumerate
10691 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
10692 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
10693 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
10694 in Tcl.
10695 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10696 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
10697 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
10698 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
10699 @end enumerate
10700
10701 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
10702 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
10703 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
10704 Everything is a string}
10705
10706 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
10707 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
10708 difference is subtle.
10709 @enumerate
10710 @item Parse Time
10711 @item Evaluation Time
10712 @end enumerate
10713
10714 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
10715 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
10716 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
10717
10718 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
10719 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
10720 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
10721 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
10722
10723 @itemize @bullet
10724 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
10725 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
10726 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
10727 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
10728 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
10729 @example
10730 # bash example
10731 X=`date`
10732 echo "The Date is: $X"
10733 # Tcl example
10734 set X [date]
10735 puts "The Date is: $X"
10736 @end example
10737 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
10738 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
10739 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
10740 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
10741 is a string}
10742 @example
10743 set x "Dinner"
10744 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
10745 @end example
10746 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
10747 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
10748 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
10749 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
10750 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
10751 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
10752 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
10753 @end itemize
10754
10755 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
10756
10757 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
10758
10759 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
10760
10761 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
10762 the normal way.
10763
10764 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
10765 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
10766 line is immediately executed.
10767
10768 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
10769 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
10770
10771 @subsection Command Execution
10772
10773 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
10774 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
10775 control flow operators.
10776
10777 Commands are executed like this:
10778
10779 @enumerate
10780 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
10781 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
10782 @item Repeat until End Of File.
10783 @end enumerate
10784
10785 It sort of works like this:
10786 @example
10787 for(;;)@{
10788 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
10789
10790 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
10791
10792 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
10793 @}
10794 @end example
10795
10796 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
10797 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
10798 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
10799 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
10800 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
10801 ``LookupCommand()''
10802
10803 @subsection The FOR command
10804
10805 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
10806 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
10807 command just like any other command.
10808
10809 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
10810 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
10811 are:
10812
10813 @enumerate 0
10814 @item The ascii text 'for'
10815 @item The start text
10816 @item The test expression
10817 @item The next text
10818 @item The body text
10819 @end enumerate
10820
10821 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
10822 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
10823 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
10824 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
10825
10826 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
10827 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
10828
10829 @example
10830 int
10831 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
10832 int *argc,
10833 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
10834 @end example
10835
10836 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
10837 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
10838 still operates in the same basic way.
10839
10840 @subsection FOR command implementation
10841
10842 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
10843 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
10844
10845 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
10846
10847 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
10848
10849 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
10850 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
10851 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
10852
10853 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
10854 expression and returns a value.
10855
10856 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
10857 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
10858 @example
10859 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
10860
10861 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
10862
10863 int
10864 MyForCommand( void *interp,
10865 int argc,
10866 char **argv )
10867 @{
10868 if( argc != 5 )@{
10869 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
10870 return ERROR;
10871 @}
10872
10873 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
10874
10875 // Execute the start statement.
10876 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
10877
10878 // Top of loop test
10879 for(;;)@{
10880 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
10881 if( i == 0 )
10882 break;
10883
10884 // Execute the body
10885 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
10886
10887 // Execute the LOOP part
10888 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
10889 @}
10890
10891 // Return no error
10892 SetResult( interp, "" );
10893 return SUCCESS;
10894 @}
10895 @end example
10896
10897 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
10898 in the same basic way.
10899
10900 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
10901
10902 @subsection source and find commands
10903 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
10904 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
10905 @*Remember the parsing rules
10906 @enumerate
10907 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
10908 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
10909 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
10910 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
10911 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
10912 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
10913 That character begins Tcl comments.)
10914 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
10915 it reads a file and executes as a script.
10916 @end enumerate
10917 @subsection format command
10918 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
10919 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
10920 @b{sprintf()}.
10921 @b{Example}
10922 @example
10923 set x 6
10924 set y 7
10925 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
10926 @end example
10927 @enumerate
10928 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
10929 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
10930 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
10931 @* Refer to Rule #1
10932 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
10933 @* Refer to Rule #1.
10934 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
10935 @end enumerate
10936 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
10937 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
10938 @example
10939 #1 Good
10940 proc someproc @{@} @{
10941 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
10942 @}
10943 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
10944 #2 Good - no variables
10945 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
10946 #3 Good Curly Braces
10947 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
10948 puts "Time: [date]"
10949 @}
10950 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
10951 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
10952 @end example
10953 @enumerate
10954 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
10955 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
10956 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
10957 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
10958 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
10959 command.
10960 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
10961 @*There are 4 examples:
10962 @enumerate
10963 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
10964 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
10965 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
10966 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
10967 @end enumerate
10968
10969 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
10970 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
10971 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
10972
10973 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
10974 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
10975 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
10976 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
10977 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
10978 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
10979 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
10980 @end enumerate
10981 @subsection Global Variables
10982 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
10983 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
10984 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
10985 @example
10986 proc myproc @{ @} @{
10987 set y 0 #Local variable Y
10988 global x #Global variable X
10989 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
10990 @}
10991 @end example
10992 @section Other Tcl Hacks
10993 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
10994 @example
10995 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
10996 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
10997 # Create var name
10998 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
10999 # Make it a global
11000 global $vn
11001 # Set it.
11002 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
11003 @}
11004 @end example
11005 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
11006 @example
11007 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
11008 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
11009 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
11010 @}
11011 @end example
11012
11013 @include fdl.texi
11014
11015 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
11016 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
11017 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
11018 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
11019 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
11020 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
11021
11022 @printindex cp
11023
11024 @node Command and Driver Index
11025 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
11026 @printindex fn
11027
11028 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)